Pat 2 Manual
Pat 2 Manual
Pat 2 Manual
VE
RO
G
T
PA
DS350 GRAPHIC
(BOOM CONTROL SYSTEM)
DS350 GRAPHIC
MODULAR
DS350 GRAPHIC
MODULAR
iFLEX5 SYSTEM
P.A.T. - L.M.I.
SYSTEM MANUAL
Description
DS350 Graphic Console Descriptions
Connections & Wiring Diagram,
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Hydraulic, Electrical
Theory & Component Location
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Boom Length
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Piston, Rod Connections
& Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Boom Angle
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Anti - Two - Block
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Digital Inputs
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Central Unit P.C. Board
Layout
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Basic Adjustments
and Checks.
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Main Board and
Transducer Replacement Procedure
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Troubleshooting Guide
Appendix: Boom Length Troubleshooting
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Electrical Diagrams
DS350 Graphic (BCS) Service Bulletins
& Miscellaneous Information
Description
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
Description
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Console
Connections, Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Component
Location
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Boom Length
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Piston, Rod
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Boom Angle
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Anti - Two - Block
Connections & Wiring Diagrams
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Digital Inputs
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Central Unit P.C.
Modular Board Layout
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Troubleshooting
Guide
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Electrical Diagrams
DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS) Service Bulletins
& Miscellaneous Information
Description
32.
33.
34.
35.
Boom Control
36.
37.
38.
Troubleshooting Moisture
39.
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 1
PAT
LOAD MOMENT INDICATOR
PAT
DS 350
STOP
STOP
156ft
0335
TARE
90.0ft
?
79.4
LIM
SEL
50.8ft
STOP
MAX
(lbs)
02 73.5oo
ACT
(lbs)
34.900
100%
100%
CTRL
100%
STOP
F1
F2
F3
F4
NOTICE:
The information in this document is subject to change without notice.
This document was created for training purposes only and should not
be a replacement for the original P.A.T.-L.M.I. operators handbook
for your specific system and crane.
1.2
2. WARNINGS
The LMI is an operational aid which warns a crane operator of approaching overload conditions and
also warns of overhoist conditions which could cause damage to equipment and personnel..
The device is not, and shall not, be a substitute for good operator judgment, experience and use
of accepted safe crane operating procedures.
The responsibility for the safe operation of the crane shall remain with the crane operator who
shall ensure that all warnings and instructions supplied are fully understood and observed.
Prior to operating the crane, the operator must carefully and thoroughly read and understand
the information in this manual to ensure that he knows the operation and limitations of the
indicator and crane.
Proper functioning is dependent upon proper daily inspection and observations of the operating
instructions set forth in this manual. We draw your attention to section 5 of this manual.
WARNING
The display will only aid the operator when the LMI is properly programmed and the
proper load capacity chart and operating code are selected for the crane configuration
being utilized. To prevent property damage or serious bodily injury or death to
personnel, ensure the LMI is properly programmed before operating the crane.
1.3
WARNING
This system is equipped with an override key on the central microprocessor unit. This key switch bypasses control lever lockout function of load moment indicator device. The switch may
only be used by authorized personnel during emergency situations. Failure to follow this instruction may result in property
damage and/or personal injury.
NORMAL OPERATION
L/O OVERRIDE
3. SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The PAT load Moment Indicator consists of a central micro processor unit, operating console, length/angle
sensor, pressure transducers and anti-two-block switches.
The system operates on the principle of reference/actual comparison. The actual value, resulting from the
force or pressure measurement is compared with the reference data, stored in the central processor
memory and evaluated in the micro processor. When limits are reached, an overload warning signal is
generated at the operators console. At the same time, the dangerous crane movements, such as hoist up,
telescope out and boom down, will be stopped.
The fixed data regarding the crane, such as load capacity charts, boom weights, centers of gravity and
dimensions are stored in memory chips in the central processor unit. This data is the reference information
used to calculate the operating conditions.
Boom length and boom angle are registered by the length/angle sensor, mounted inside the cable reel
which is mounted on the boom. The boom length is measured by the cable reel cable which also serves
as an electrical conductor for the anti-two-block switches.
The crane load is measured by pressure transducers attached to the piston and rod side of the lift cylinders.
1.4
VE
GRO
NOTE:
If PAT System is to be used in
conjunction with a jib having an
existing Grove/Krueger Anti-TwoBlock system, a special connector
cable is required. Consult Grove
customer services for requirement.
3
4
5
CONSOLE
4
2
1 ANTI-TWO-BLOCK SWITCHES
2 PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS
3 LENGTH/ANGLE SENSOR-ANTITWO-BLOCK CABLE REEL
4 OPERATING CONSOLE
5 CENTRAL MICRO PROCESSOR UNIT
1.5
Start
Self check of
LMI System
Error?
Error code
yes
no
yes
Within
2 hours?
no
Interactive
INPUT
operating mode
Interactive
INPUT
reevings
Inputs
OK?
yes
Ready for
Operation
4 SYSTEMS OPERATION
During the startup phase the crane operator will receive information about the function and meaning of the various elements of
the console. This process will also remind the crane operator to follow the respective operating instructions.
During the pre-setup phase the crane operator will receive general information about his responsibility by operating the crane.
If the operator is experienced and totally familiar with the function and operation of the system he can go directly to the
programming procedure at the end of this PRE-SETUP phase.
When the crane engine is restarted after less than approximately two hours, the PRE-SETUP and Information Run
will be skipped.
4.1 Pre-Setup
The PRE-SETUP is a simple step by step procedure. The information will be displayed until a button is pressed to call for the
next info step. The PRE-SETUP is followed by the Info Run or by the programming phase.
1.6
FIND OPERATOR
MANUALS
READ AND UNDERSTAND
* PUSH INFO
Prior to operating, the operator shall carefully and thoroughly read and understand
the crane load capacity charts and the information contained in the manuals for the
crane and the LMI, to ensure that the operator knows the operation and limitations
of the crane and the LMI.
The load moment indicator (LMI) is a system which supports an operator in his
action to operate the crane.
But the system cannot be 100% fail-safe and not all causes for danger can be
recognized at the same time.
For the loading capacity of the crane only the load capacity charts are relevant. The
operator shall also observe the operating instructions in the load capacity charts.
The load values in the load capacity chart shall under no circumstances be
exceeded. It is essential to select the correct operating code number which is
also printed in the load capacity chart.
IF IN DOUBT CONSULT
THE OPERATOR MANUALS
BEFORE OPERATING THE
CRANE
* PUSH INFO
He has to make sure that the crane is in good condition and that he works on a firm
and level supporting surface. The operator shall fully acquaint himself with the
most recent government regulations and industry standards relevant to safe craning
operations.
If there is anything unclear or if there are doubts about operating the crane or LMI,
the operator shall consult the operator manuals before operating the crane.
1.7
PATDS 350
12
STOP
Legend to Fig. 2 :
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
F1
F2
F3
F4
LC Display Area
Load Moment Limit Light
Load Moment Prewarning Light
Alarm Light Anti - Two - Block
Override Key Warning Light
Button Alarm Stop
Button and Control Light TARE
Button and Control Light LIMITS
Button and Control Light SELECT
OPERATION MODE
Button and Control Light INFO
Button and Control Light CONTROL
Audible Alarm
By-Pass Key Switch
Button and Control Light By-Pass
ANTI - TWO - BLOCK
Button and Control Light By-Pass
LMI SHUT-OFF FUNCTION
Button Function 1
Button Function 2
Button Function 3
Button Function 4
STOP
7
3
TARE
!
8 LIM
9 SEL
STOP
14
STOP
15
F1
13
1.8
F2
F3
F4
10
11
CTRL
1.
2.
3.
STOP
4.
5.
STOP
STOP
6.
The red Override Key Warning Light flashes when the bypass key switch
is turned and the button is pushed. This switch deactivates the cut-off function
of the LMI.
WARNING
Should the red override key warning light continue to flash (with the by-pass
key switch in the neutral position) , the LMI override key switch located
on the central processing unit (CPU) has been positioned in the lockout override
position. This key switch continually by-passes the control lever lockout
function of the load moment indicator device.
The Alarm Stop Button allows the audible alarm to be silenced for
approximately 15 seconds by pressing this button.
The Tare Button is used to indicate the net load on the display. Net load is the
actual load, less lifting tackle and hook block. The Tare Button has to be
activated before lifting.
7.
TARE
After pushing the Tare Button before lifting, the display of actual load will be
set to zero (taring). After pushing the tare button the display shows max. load,
net load and radius. Net load display is blinking and set to zero. After lifting a
load the net load display shows the net load (pay load).
The net load display will change to the normal working display when the
boom radius is changed (either by angle or length).
1.9
8.
9.
LIM
SEL
If, during the crane operation, you wish to change the crane
configuration, this button can be pushed for quick setting
without having to go through the whole LMI programming
procedure again. (ie. Hoist Reeving, Hoist, Extension)
10.
CTRL
11.
PAT
12.
13.
B
With the system being ready for operation, this function serves
to display the system configuration.
The display shows the crane symbol representing the adjusted
configuration (marked in black), the extended operating code
number and the reeving number.
This function serves for the contrast adjustment of the LC display.
The last adjustment is stored and does not have to be repeated at
every system start.
When turned to position B the KEY SWITCH serves to release the function :
- deactivate the cut-off function of the LMI
- deactivate the cut-off function of the
anti-two-block switch
It can be operated only by using the matching key
WARNING
Since buttons (14) and (15) deactivate the cut-off function of the LMI system
/ the anti-two-block system, the following instructions must be obeyed.
- The by-pass function shall be used with discretion, as unwarranted use
of it to override the control lever lockout system can result in harm to the
crane and danger to property and persons.
- Never use the by-pass function to either overload or operate the crane in
a non permissible range.
1.10
14.
15.
STOP
1.11
WARNING
Failure to re-position the anti-two-block switch weight will prevent the
overhoist system from functioning properly. No weight shall be on the main
hoist anti-two-block switch when the boom extention or jib is being used.
3
1
5
2
4
Fig. 1 : Setting of Anti-Two-Block
Retainer in Locking Position
1.13
B
A
3
1
4
2
Fig. 3 : Removal of the Anti-TwoBlock Retainer
WARNING
The following test shall be performed with care to prevent
damage to the machine or injury to personnel. Proper functioning
of the system requires successful completion of these test before
operating the machine.
1.14
If the operator cannot see the load handling device approaching the boom nose, he shall have an assistant
(signal person) watch the load handling device. The operator shall be prepared to stop the machine
immediately should the LMI system not function properly as indicated by lighting the red warning light,
sounding the alarm and locking the crane movements, hoist up, telescope out and boom down.
Check the anti-two-block alarm light and the audible alarm by performing one of the following test:
1. By manually lifting the weight attached to the anti-two-block switches. When the
weight is lifted, the audible alarm should sound, the anti-two-block alarm light
should light.
2. Slowly raise the main boom load handling device to create a potential two -block
condition. When the load handling device lifts the weight, the audible alarm
should sound, the anti-two-block light should light and the motion of the load
handling device should be stopped. Lower the load handling device slightly to
eliminate this condition.
3. Slowly lower the boom to create a potential two -block condition. When
the load handling device lifts the weight, the audible alarm should sound,
the anti-two-block light should light and the boom lowering function
should be stopped. Lower the load handling device slightly to eliminate
this condition.
4. Slowly extend (telescope) the main boom to create a potential two -block
condition. When the load handling device lifts the weight, the audible alarm
should sound, the anti-two-block light should light and the boom telescope out
function should be stopped. Lower the load handling device slightly to
eliminate this condition.
1.15
7. Check that the display of the main boom angle agrees with the actual boom angles.
8. Check that the display of the operating radius of the crane agrees with the actual radius.
9. Check the load display by lifting a load of known weight. The accuracy of the load
indication shall be within the tolerance of SAE J159.
Operation
After being properly programmed, the LMI is operational. Therefore, the operator shall be thoroughly
familiar with all controls of the LMI and he shall properly set each switch before operating the crane.
All settings shall be checked by lifting a load of known weight and comparing the load to the information
displayed on the LMI.
Rated loads include the weight of the hook block, slings, and auxilliary load handling devices. Their
combined weights shall be subtracted from the listed load capacities as stated on the load capacity
chart to obtain the net load to be lifted.
WARNING
If any of the displays reflect a deviation between displayed and
actual values an authorized PAT service representative shall
be called for repair of the system or reverification of the cranes
LMI calibration.
WARNING
Any structural modifications or changes to the crane shall
require reverification of the cranes LMI calibration.
7. Troubleshooting
General
In case of a malfunction of the system, the display (1) will indicate a code which identifies the system
malfunction.
The error codes listed in the Malfunction Table will identify various faults which can occur with the LMI.
Following the Malfunction Table there is information which will explain each fault and describe the action
which shall be taken to correct the fault.
Faults within the electronic microprocessor shall be repaired by factory trained service personnel. When
these faults occur, the competent service organization shall shall be contacted.
Malfunction Table
Error Code
E01
E02
E03
E04
E05
E06
Error
Fallen below the radius or above angle range
Radius range exceeded or fallen below angle range
Boom position is out of the permissible working area
Operating mode not existing
Prohibited length range
Radius range exceeded or fallen below jib angle range
NOTE:
If there is any Error Code displayed on the console which is not listed in the Malfunctions Table you shall
call the Local Distributor.
Operating Errors
Malfunctions in the system which are caused by range exceedings or operating errors by the crane operator
himself are indicated on the display together with an explanation. These error codes are E01, E02, E03, E04,
E05 and E06 and they can normally be eliminated by the crane operator himself.
1.17
ERROR 01
E01: ABOVE ANGLE
RANGE
ANGLE = 80.0 o
Cause:
Fallen below the minimum radius
or above the angle given in the
load capacity chart due to raising
the boom too far.
Elimination:
Lower boom back to a radius or
angle given in the load capacity
chart.
ERROR 02
E02: BELOW ANGLE
RANGE
ANGLE = 25.0 o
Cause:
The maximum radius or minimum
angle given in the load capacity
chart was exceeded due to lowering the boom too far.
Elimination:
Raise boom back to a radius or
angle given in the load capacity
chart.
ERROR 03
E03: NO - LOAD AREA
Cause:
Boom position is out of the permissible working area (over front)
Elimination:
Move boom back to permissible working area. See lifting
diagram in the load capacity
charts.
1.18
ERROR 04
E04: OPERATING MODE
NOT AVAILABLE
SEE LOAD CAPACITY
CHART * PUSH INFO
Cause: 1
Operating mode switch in the console set incorrectly.
Elimination:
Set operating mode switch correctly to the code assigned to the
operating mode of the crane.
Cause: 2
Elimination:
Operating mode is not permissible Be sure crane is set up according
with the actual crane configuration, to proper operating configurboom position or area definition.
ations.
ERROR 05
E05: LENGTH RANGE
NOT PERMITTED
LENGTH = 75.3 ft
Cause: 1
Elimination:
Boom was telescoped too far or not Telescope boom to correct
far enough, i.e. load curves for on length, given in the load capacity
rubber, you may only operate up to chart.
a certain maximum or minimum
boom length or with load curves
for jibs where you have to telescope
the main boom to a certain length.
Cause: 2
Length sensor adjustment changed
i.e. length sensor cable slid off the
length sensor drum.
Elimination:
For elimination refer to service
manual.
1.19
ERROR 06
E06: RADIUS RANGE
EXCEEDED
RADIUS = 96.6 ft
Cause:
The minimum angle or maximum
radius of the luffing fly jib given in
the load capacity chart was exceeded
due to lowering the jib too far.
Elimination:
Raise jib back to an angle given
in the load capacity chart.
Lightbar
The P.A.T. Lightbar is a supplementary indicator for the standard P.A.T. Load Moment Indicator systems.
It displays the load moment in form of a bargraph. The lightbar is located in the operators cab in front of
the operator.
DIM
STOP
This indicator display how much of the crane capacity is being used. As the crane is moved through its
various motions, the bargraph will constantly change.
The range of the bargraph is divided into three areas:
- the green area is the normal working area,
- the yellow prewarning area shows the remaining portion of the rated load capacity and
the bargraph indicates the approach to the overload condition,
- the red area shows that the maximum rated load capacity is exceeded.
1.20
CONSOLE MEASUREMENT:
CONNECTION BOARD W/VOLTMETER ON X1:30 & X1:33
VOLTMETER SHOULD MEASURE +24V BETWEEN CONNECTIONS
X1 - 33 (NEGATIVE) AND X1 - 30 (POSITIVE).
H8
V2
X3
H7
A2B K9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
SHUT
OFF
H4
H1
V8
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
OUTER
MID
V11
R15
V1
K7
R16
R9
V5
K4
K1
+24.0
R10
R3
R4
R17
R18
H10
H5
H3
R13
K6
R14
R11
R12
R7
V3
R8
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
R5
R2
R6
F4
IM
X1
77 76 75
K3
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
X1
80 79 78
V6
D
RO
F5
F6
X1
R1
49 48 47
SE
F7
K5
4W
70 69 68
CM
OM
F8
V7
ROD
DRAIN
X4
V9
4 - WAY
CENTER
MID
V10
X1
H2
INNER
MID
H6
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H9
X1
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
X1
2 4 6
1 2 3 4
1 3 5
X4
F3
F2
59 58 57 56 55 54 53
X1
52 51 50
X1
43 42 41
40 39 38
X1
37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30
46 45 44
X1
1.21
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
DS350 Graphic
Console to C.P.U.
Connections
6
5
LMI BY - PASS
KEY
14
o o
o o
13
LMI BUTTON
BY - PASS
A2B BUTTON
BY - PASS
CONSOLE
BY-PASS
KEY
DI (8)
LMI (7)
A2B (6)
COMM. (5)
RXD (4)
DATA TO C.U.
TXD (3)
2
1
2
3
4
1
GND (2)
+24V (1)
1.22
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
o
o30
o
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
PAT
DS 350
STOP
STOP
156ft
0335
TARE
90.0ft
?
Ramp Seq.
CM Hex Value
IM Hex Value
79.4
255
SEL
STOP
LIM
255
50.8ft
MAX
02
38.2
38.2
38.2
38.2
100%
(lbs)
73.5oo
ACT
(lbs)
34.900
100%
i
CTRL
100%
STOP
F1
Length of IM
F2
F3
F4
Tot. Length
minus IM
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 2
2. Warnings
The DS 350 load moment indicator (LMI) with boom control extension is an operational
aid that warns the crane operator when he approaches an overload condition, a two block
condition and an out of boom sequence condition. The boom control extension controls
the sequence of the boom during operation. It still remains the operators responsibility to
select verify the operation and to select the correct mode during crane operations.
The manual mode is a rigging mode. Lifting loads with manual mode programmed is
prohibited.
Should an out of sequence condition occur, the crane operator is responsible to select
manual mode to return the sections into sequence before he continues the lift.
The responsibility for safe crane operation shall remain with the crane operator who shall
ensure that all warnings and instructions supplied are fully understood and observed.
Prior to operating the crane, the operator must carefully and thoroughly read and
understand the information provided by the crane and load moment indicator
manufacturer.
Proper functioning depends upon proper daily inspection and observance of the operating
instructions provided with the crane and load moment indicator.
2.1
Operator moves
control to extend or
retract position.
Directional pressure
switch transmits signal
to B.C.S.
off
Operation in manual
mode - no control
output.
correct
Console displays
length and % of each
section.
on
incorrect
2.2
2.3
TM9150, TM9100
continuation
incorrect
correct
Out of sequence
warning and lock out.
2.4
Model
TM 9150
TM 9100
TMS 870
TTS 870
RT 865 BXL
2.5
Mode
B
A, B
A, B
A, B
B
The following switches are located inside, and on the upper right hand side of the cab directly above the
window.
2.6
2.7
CENTER
MID
ON
INNER
MID
CENTER
MID
BOOM
MODE
INNER
MID
ON
OUTER
MID
FLY
BOOM TELE
SECTION SELECT
OUTER MID
FLY
ON
M
A
N
U
A
L
A
U
T
O
BOOM
NOT
SYNC
B
BOOM
TELE MODE
BOOM
TELESCOPE
SYSTEM
2.8
2.9
SEQUENCE
VALVE
1000 PSI
TELE
EXTEND
THIRD WRAP
K11
K12
MH
AH
VALVE CONTROL
BOARD
A111
DIGITAL INPUT
EXTENSION BOARD
A112
DECODER
BOARD
A110
DIODE
BOARD
A113
X1 TERMINAL
BOARD A104
2.10
MAIN
BOARD
A101
2.11
(BOTTOM VIEW
OF C.P.U.)
FUSE (2A)
FUSE (10A)
2.12
(BOTTOM VIEW
OF C.P.U.)
FUSE (2A)
FUSE (10A)
INNER MID
PILOT
INNER MID
RED
GREEN
CYL
CABLE
INNER MID
BLACK
WHITE
PILOT
INNER MID
CYLINDER
OUTER MID
PILOT
OUTER MID
CYLINDER
CENTER MID
CYLINDER
CENTER MID
PILOT
OUTER MID
BLACK
WHITE
CYL
B
CENTER MID
RED
GREEN
CYL
OUTER MID
BLACK
WHITE
PILOT
C
CENTER MID
RED
GREEN
PILOT
2.13
2.14
See detail
A
See detail
C
IM % reset
switch
PAT
See detail
C
CM retract and %
reset switch
IM retract
switch
PAT
OM retract and %
reset switch
See detail
C
IM length sensor
LG221
PAT
2.15
PAT
PAT
PAT
2.16
0.13
18
See detail
A
See detail
B
0.44
3.94
16
1.34
PAT
DETAIL C
CENTER LINE OF
TARGETS &
PROXIMITY SW.
0.44
0.44
18
16
1.0
To
wi be a
t
of h c e ligne
n
ca
bl e t e r l d
ree ine
ld
rum
DETAIL B
DETAIL A
2.17
19
19
CENTER LINE OF
CABLE REEL DRUM
2.18
Sequence valve
The sequence valve maintains pressure on the rod side to prevent the cylinders from extending when
the trombone tubes are pressurized.
* If the boom sections drift back in momentarily after the controller is released, this is a good indication
the sequence valve is defective.
* To adjust or check for proper adjustment:
1. Install gauge into test port between pressure reducing valve and sequence valve.
2. Select manual mode.
3. Select either inner mid or center mid section.
4. Extend the boom section and monitor pressure while boom is extending. If it does not
read 1,000 P.S.I., adjust valve accordingly.
Pressure reducing valve
The pressure reducing valve is used to flood the rod side whenever the telescope cylinders first
begin to extend.
* If the boom sections take off with a jump, this is a good indication the pressure reducing valve
is defective.
* To adjust or check for proper adjustment:
1. Always be sure to check setting of the sequence valve first.
2. Gauge should still be in test port from checking sequence valve.
3. With manual mode still selected.
4. Select either the inner mid or center mid section chosen.
5. Extend the section completely until it bottoms out.
6. Release controller or treadle valve to neutral (this allows oil to drain off).
7. Then operate controller or treadle valve to extend and note pressure reading, it should
read 800 P.S.I. if it does not, adjust pressure reducing valve accordingly.
Check valve
The purpose of the check valve, is to prevent high pressure oil from flowing back through the
800 P.S.I. pressure reducing valve when trying to retract.
2.19
ELECTRIC
Automatic Mode
Proportional voltage is sent by the PAT system to the coils on the 4 - way valve, either to the extend or
the retract side as determined by the pressure switches in the joystick lines an the K-5 relay in the PAT
system. The current is applied gradually and removed gradually by the PAT system to assure smooth
starts and transitions between boom section change over.
Extending the inner mid
The proportional output building up while extending the inner mid followed by full current and a fully
open valve while extending, followed by a decrease in current during the change over to the center mid.
Once all the 2 way valves for the appropriate sections have changed over and the rod and piston side have
dumped momentarily, the current will be reapplied proportionally to allow a smooth start of the center
mid. K-5 relay remains energized during the entire process. This is because the operator never left off on
the controller and the extend pressure switch always remained in the on position.
Retracting the inner mid
While retracting the inner mid, followed by full current and a fully open valve while extending, followed
by a decrease in current during the change over to the center mid. Once all the 2 way valves for the
appropriate sections have changed over the piston side dump valve stayed energized before, during , and
after the change over took place, while the rod side dump valve energized briefly during the change over.
This was because we were retracting, and no pilot pressure was seen on the extend side, and therefore our
normally closed pressure switch kept the piston side dump valve energized and K - 5 relay which directs
the proportional voltage never energized. This is a default mode so that if there is an electrical problem
current could always be applied to the retract side to bring in the boom in for repairs.
Manual Mode
Extending the inner and center mid
Any time manual mode is selected voltage to the proportional solenoids is at maximum voltage. This
means the 4 way valve will respond directly to the input from the controller, without the ramp up and
ramp down feature as provided when under control by the PAT system. The 2 way valves for the
appropriate sections are controlled by the manual switch. Although it is not required to release the
controller to neutral when changing boom sections, it is preferred. When releasing the controller to
neutral the rod side and piston side will drain, which will allow for a smooth transition between boom
sections when on manual mode. Note that K-5 relay never energizes, now that we are in manual mode
both coils on the 4 - way valve will remain energized with full voltage.
Retracting the inner and center mid
Anytime manual mode is selected voltage to the proportional solenoids is at maximum voltage.
The two way valves for the appropriate sections are controlled by the manual switch. The rod side valve
energizes briefly as we stop controller input to change sections, and the piston side dump valve is not
energized during retraction.
2.20
OM 2 - WAYS
CM 2 - WAYS
ANALOG SIG. - RET. VALVE
ANALOG SIG. - EXT. VALVE
SIG. ANALOG OUTPUT BOR.
TELE OUT OF SEQ.
F2
GND
+24 V
10 A
3
2
1
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
o
30
o o
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
87A
87
DS350 Graphic
X1 Terminal Board
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
o
o30
o
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
1
2
3
4
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
X5
-SIG
-5V
40
COND.
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
X6
ANGLE
26
COND.
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
2.21
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
X4
MEMORY
EXTENSION
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
LENGTH
RESET SW.
MEASURE
PINS
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
DE 6
2X SERIAL
INTERFACE
F1
2A
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
X1
(
(
(
3
2
1
X7
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
X9
BR14
w
w
w
PILOT
w
TEST PORT
800 PSI
ROD
DRAIN
TO DUAL RETURN
MANIFOLD
PISTON
DRAIN
.078
w
P1
w
PRESSURE
SWITCH
EXTEND
P2
TO CASE
DRAIN
MANIFOLD
RET
EXT
PRESSURE
SWITCH
EXTEND
EXT
B A P1 D
RET
B A
49.9
GPM
P1
GP
220300
3650
w
w
3800
SEQUENCE
VALVE
WITH CHECK
1000 PSI
1500
3000
w
LS
TELE
P2
LIFT
OPEN
PRESSURE
SWITCH
RETRACT
OUT
TO DRAIN MANIFOLD
2.22
PILOT
800 PSI
K3
ROD
DRAIN
w
PRESSURE
SWITCH
EXTEND
P2
NO
TO CASE
DRAIN
MANIFOLD
DI 1
RET
NC
EXT
PRESSURE
SWITCH
EXTEND
EXT
P1 D
RET
49.9
GPM
P1
GP
K5
220300
3650
w
3800
K5
3000
SEQUENCE
VALVE
WITH CHECK
1000 PSI
PISTON
DRAIN
.078
TO DUAL RETURN
MANIFOLD
P1
1500
w
LS
TELE
P2
DI 2
LIFT
NO
OUT
PRESSURE
SWITCH
RETRACT
TO DRAIN MANIFOLD
2.23
w
2.24
PILOT
255
CENTER MID
INNER MID
50
40
3
Proportional
solenoid
valve 1
Proportional solenoid
valve 2
4 sec.
0
40
47
50
2 sec.
RT 865BXL
TTS/TMS 870
1
2
Minimum ramping
value CM
Ramping down
Minimum ramping
value IM
2.25
Length
[%]
EXTEND
CENTER MID
PROPORTIONAL
OUTPUT
PROPORTIONAL VALVE
START
OM
2 WAYS
CM
2 WAYS
CHANGE OVER
CLOSED
OPEN
CLOSED
OPEN
CLOSED
IM
2 WAYS
OPEN
OPEN
OPEN
ROD
DRAIN
OPEN
CLOSED
K5
RELAY
OPEN
CLOSED
OPEN
PISTON
DRAIN
STOP
OPEN
CLOSED
OPEN
CLOSED
EXTEND
2.26
RETRACT
CENTER MID
PROPORTIONAL
OUTPUT
PROPORTIONAL VALVE
START
CHANGE OVER
STOP
CLOSED
OM
2 WAYS
OPEN
CLOSED
CM
2 WAYS
OPEN
CLOSED
IM
2 WAYS
OPEN
OPEN
OPEN
ROD
DRAIN
OPEN
CLOSED
OPEN
CLOSED
PISTON
DRAIN
K5
RELAY
2.27
EXTEND
INNER MID
EXTEND
CENTER MID
PROPORTIONAL VALVE
START
CHANGE OVER
STOP
CLOSED
OM
2 WAYS
OPEN
CLOSED
CM
2 WAYS
OPEN
CLOSED
IM
2 WAYS
OPEN
OPEN
OPEN
ROD
DRAIN
OPEN
CLOSED
CLOSED
OPEN
PISTON
DRAIN
OPEN
OPEN
CLOSED
OPEN
CLOSED
K5
RELAY
2.28
RETRACT
INNER MID
RETRACT
CENTER MID
PROPORTIONAL VALVE
START
CHANGE OVER
STOP
OM
2 WAYS
CLOSED
CM
2 WAYS
OPEN
CLOSED
IM
2 WAYS
OPEN
OPEN
OPEN
ROD
DRAIN
OPEN
CLOSED
OPEN
CLOSED
PISTON
DRAIN
K5
RELAY
2.29
K6
1
0
1
0
0
K7
1
1
0
0
0
DESCRIPTION
IM EXTENDING OR RETRACTING
CM EXTENDING OR RETRACTING
OM/FLY EXTENDING OR RETRACTING
OUT OF SEQUENCE
NEUTRAL POSITION
Rod side dump valve logic TMS/TTS 870 and RT 865 BXL
Note: K3 is energized in neutral controller position or during the change over transition
while both section do not move.
DI 1
EXTEND SELECT
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
DI 2
RETRACT
SELECT
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
DI 4
OM/FLY
RETRACTED
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
DI 5
IM & CM
RETRACTED
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Analog Outputs
ANALOG
1
1
CU
DESCRIPTION
TERMINAL
A111 X1/5 Analog GND for proportional extend or retract solenoid valves.
A111 X1/6 Analog signal for proportional extend or retract solenoid valves.
2.30
K3
ROD DRAIN
SOLENOID
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Ext. auto IM
Ret. auto IM
Ext. auto CM
Ret. auto CM
Ext. auto OM
Ret. auto OM
Ext.
DI 1
1
0
1
0
1
0
Ext. manual IM
Ret. manual IM
Ext. manual CM
Ret. manual CM
Ext. manual OM
Ret.manual OM
neutral
Retr.
DI 2
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
Relay
K2
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
Relay
K6
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Relay
K7
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Relay
K5
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2 way
IM
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2.31
2 way
CM
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
2 way
OM
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
analog
output
board
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
Prop.Valve
ext.
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Prop Valve
retr.
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
IM %
0
50
50
75
75
100
100
100
CM %
0
0
50
50
75
75
100
100
OM %
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
100
FLY %
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
100
AUTO A
AUTO A
AUTO A
AUTO A
0
0
0
100
0
100
100
100
0
0
100
100
0
0
100
100
Boom sequence TMS/TTS 870, RT 865 BXL, TM 9100 AND TM9150 boom extensions
Mode
AUTO
AUTO
AUTO
IM %
100
100
100
CM %
0
100
100
OM %
0
0
100
2.32
FLY %
0
0
100
800 milliamps at the Proportional coils results in full pilot flow to valve.
6. Wire 239 to the Proportional coils is ground, but must never be grounded to crane ground, as it is also
an analog signal to the PAT as well.
7.
E-07 error code is generated from voltage noise created across the extend and retract pressures
switches. Suppression diodes have been installed from input to ground
(# 38 to # 37 ) to clip the spikes.
8.
9. 4 proximity switches located on left side of boom indicate to the PAT that boom sections are fully
retracted, at which time the PAT will automatically reset the retracted boom length percentage as
shown:
OM / Fly
Mid
IM
IM
0%
0%
1%
0 % ( with boom stop pulled down )
2.33
HELPFUL HINTS
CHECKING THE COILS IN THE TWO WAY VALVES FOR CONTINUITY
1. Select manual mode
2. Select individual sections to operate.
3. If there is continuity in the wiring to the valve, the section lights will illuminate.
2.34
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 3
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
DS350 Graphic
Boom Length to C.P.U.
Connections
LG 208 CABLE REEL
(TO NOSE)
17
18
R.F.
FILTERS
10
9
6
7
6
A
B
CORE
1
2
1 2 3
3
4
2
LG
4.7K
SHIELD
1
PIN 1 & 5 = GND
PIN 3 & 6 = -5V
PIN 2 = LENGTH SIGNAL
5
6
1
2
Boom Base
Junction Box
1
A 1
B 2
C 3
3
2
1
TERMINALS :
1-2 & 4-5
ARE JUMP
TOGETHER
3.1
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
o
30
o o
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
87A
87
85
F8
86
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
o
o30
o
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
o
o30
o
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
DS350 Graphic
Boom Length to C.P.U.
Connections
LWG 221 CABLE REEL
(TO CM)
20
19
18
17
16
TERMINALS FOR
PROX. SWITCHES
SEE PG. 12.1-12.4
15
14
13
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
Boom Base
Junction Box
12
11
10
A 1
2 10 H 8
8
7
C 3
13 6
D 4
LG
WG
6
5
4
13
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
TERMINALS :
1-2 & 4-5
ARE JUMP
TOGETHER
3
4
1
3.2
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
o
o30
o
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
DS350 Graphic
Boom Length to C.P.U.
Connections
LG 221 CABLE REEL
(TO IM)
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
TERMINALS FOR
PROX. SWITCHES
SEE PG. 12.1-12.4
13
Boom Base
Junction Box
12
11
10
9
8
A 1
G 7
C 3
7
6
5
LG
4
3
TERMINALS :
1-2 & 4-5
ARE JUMP
TOGETHER
7
BOOM LENGTH SIGNAL
RETRACTED = -0.500V
MAX RANGE = -4.5V
* NOTE - MAX LENGTH SIGNAL
VARIES WITH BOOM
MAX VOLTAGE - 4.5V IS
FOR 10 TURNS ON POT.
3
1
3.3
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
o
o30
o
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
3.4
CHANNEL # 1
NO. OF TURNS
NO. OF TURNS
"INPUT" SIGNAL AT "OUTPUT" SIGNAL AT
ON CABLE REEL ON LENGTH POT. TERM. X1-10 IN C.U. MP 6 TEST POINT ON
MAIN BOARD IN C.U.
0
0
-0.5V
0.5V
3
1
-0.9V
0.9V
6
2
-1.30V
1.30V
9
3
-1.70V
1.70V
12
4
-2.10V
2.10V
15
5
-2.50V
2.50V
18
6
-2.90V
2.90V
21
7
-3.30V
3.30V
24
8
-3.70V
3.70V
27
9
-4.10V
4.10V
30
10
-4.50V
4.50V
PAT DS350Graphic(BCS)
MAIN BOOM LENGTH SIGNAL VOLTAGE
X1
CABLE REEL
ASSY
0.0V
(GND)
ERROR
CODE
FIXED
RESISTOR
3 : 1 RATIO
ZERO ADJUSTMENT
RETRACTED BOOM
3.5
PRELOAD SPRING
30 REVOLUTIONS
COUNTERCLOCKWISE
(CENTER REEL)
CH. #1
OPERATING
WINDOW
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
LENGTH SENSOR
10 K /10 TURNS
.0V
E 11
.500V MIN.
WORKING
RANGE
ERROR
CODE
- 500MV (-.500V)
MINIMUM SIGNAL
(RETRACTED BOOM)
4.50V MAX.
E 21
5.0V
10
AMP
TO A/D
CONVERTER
MP 6
TEST POINT
- 4.50V
MAXIMUM SIGNAL
(10 TURNS ON POT)
MP 6 VOLTAGES
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL
(RETRACTED BOOM)
+4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL
(10 TURNS ON POT)
ALL VOLTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1-8 ON A104OR MP 15
ON MAIN BOARD).
X1
CENTRAL UNIT
TERMINAL BOARD
WIRE NUMBER
TEST POINT
ON MAIN BOARD
FIXED
RESISTOR
11
-5V
X1
LENGTH MEASUREMENT:
CABLE REEL W/VOLTMETER ON 1 & 2
W/VOLTMETER ON 1 & 3
WITH THE BOOM FULLY RETRACTED THE VOLTMETER SHOULD
MEASURE -0.50 VOLTS BETWEEN CONNECTIONS 1 (GND) AND
2 (SIGNAL VOLTAGE).
VOLTMTER SHOULD MEASURE -5.0 VOLTS BETWEEN
CONNECTIONS 1 (GND) AND 3 (SUPPLY VOLTAGE).
-0.50
-5.00
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213 1415 16
3.6
PAT
PAT
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112 131415 16
3.7
LENGTH MEASUREMENT:
CONNECTION BOARD W/VOLTMETER ON X1:8 & X1:11
VOLTMETER SHOULD MEASURE -5.0 VOLTS BETWEEN CONNECTIONS
X1 - 8 (NEGATIVE) AND X1 - 11 (POSITIVE).
H8
V2
X3
H7
A2B K9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
SHUT
OFF
H4
H1
V8
R15
V5
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
OUTER
MID
V11
K7
K4
R9
R10
R16
V1
K1
R3
R4
R17
R18
H10
H5
H6
H3
R14
R8
R5
V3
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
R2
R6
F4
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
IM
X1
77 76 75
D
RO
F5
X1
80 79 78
X1
R1
49 48 47
Q
F6
R7
SE
F7
R12
4W
70 69 68
CM
OM
F8
R11
K3
INNER
MID
R13
K5
V6
ROD
DRAIN
K6
X1
H2
V7
4 - WAY
X4
V9
CENTER
MID
V10
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H9
X1
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
-5.00
X1
2 4 6
1 2 3 4
1 3 5
X4
F3
F2
59 58 57 56 55 54 53
X1
52 51 50
X1
43 42 41
40 39 38
X1
37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30
46 45 44
X1
3.8
LENGTH MEASUREMENT:
CONNECTION BOARD W/VOLTMETER ON X1:8 & X1:10
WITH BOOM FULLY RETRACTED THEVOLTMETER SHOULD MEASURE
-0.50 VOLTS BETWEEN CONNECTIONS X1 - 8 (NEGATIVE)
AND X1 - 10 (POSITIVE).
H8
V2
X3
H7
A2B K9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
SHUT
OFF
H4
H1
V8
K7
V5
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
OUTER
MID
V11
R15
V1
K4
R9
R10
R16
K1
R3
R4
R17
R18
H10
H5
H3
R13
K6
R14
R11
R12
R7
V3
R8
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
R5
R2
R6
F4
IM
X1
77 76 75
K3
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
X1
80 79 78
V6
D
RO
F5
F6
X1
R1
49 48 47
SE
F7
K5
4W
70 69 68
CM
OM
F8
V7
ROD
DRAIN
X4
V9
4 - WAY
CENTER
MID
V10
X1
H2
INNER
MID
H6
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H9
X1
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
-0.50
X1
2 4 6
1 2 3 4
1 3 5
X4
F3
F2
59 58 57 56 55 54 53
X1
52 51 50
X1
43 42 41
40 39 38
X1
37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30
46 45 44
X1
3.9
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 4
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
DS350 Graphic
Piston Pressure
Transducer to C.P.U.
Connections
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
14
o o
o o
13
PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
PISTON SIDE
DAVS
4
3
2
1
4.1
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
o
o30
o
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
4.2
PRESSURE
(P.S.I.)
"INPUT" SIGNAL AT
TERM. X1-21 IN
CENTRAL UNIT
0 MV.
-33.3 MV.
-66.6 MV.
-99.9 MV.
-133.3 MV.
-166.6 MV.
-199.9 MV.
-233.2 MV.
-266.6 MV.
-299.9 MV.
-333.2 MV.
-366.5 MV.
-399.9 MV.
-433.2 MV.
-466.5 MV.
-499.8 MV.
-533.1 MV.
-566.5 MV.
-599.8 MV.
-633.1 MV.
-666.4 MV.
-699.7 MV.
-733.1 MV.
-766.4 MV.
-799.7 MV.
-833.1 MV.
-866.3 MV.
-899.7 MV.
-932.9 MV.
-966.3 MV.
-999.9 MV.
CHANNEL # 2
"OUTPUT" SIGNAL AT MP 4
TEST POINT ON MAIN
BOARD IN C.U.
0.5 V.
0.63 V.
0.77 V.
0.89 V.
1.03 V.
1.17 V.
1.29 V.
1.43 V.
1.53 V.
1.69 V.
1.83 V.
1.97 V.
2.09 V.
2.23 V.
2.36 V.
2.49 V.
2.63 V.
2.76 V.
2.89 V.
3.03 V.
3.16 V.
3.29 V.
3.43 V.
3.56 V.
3.69 V.
3.83 V.
3.96 V.
4.09 V.
4.23 V.
4.36 V.
4.50 V.
4.3
DAVS 301
PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
(PISTON SIDE)
TEST POINT
ON MAIN BOARD
WIRE NUMBER
CENTRAL UNIT
TERMINAL BOARD
PRESSURE
FROM PISTON SIDE
OF LIFT CYLINDERS
X1
D
C
B
18
X1
19
20
21
AMP
P4
0.0V
(GND)
- 5.0V
TO A/D
CONVERTER
5.0V
MP 4 VOLTAGES
MP 4
TEST POINT
E 22
4.50V MAX.
.500V MIN.
ERROR
CODE
WORKING
RANGE
E 12
.0V
ERROR
CODE
P4 ZERO POINT
ADJUSTMENT
+ 5.0V
OUTPUT SIGNAL :
ZERO PRESSURE = 0.000V
MAX. PRESSURE = -1.0V
(+ / - 25 MV)
X1
CH. #2
OPERATING
WINDOW
H8
V2
H4
V1
A2B K9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
SHUT
OFF
H1
V5
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
V8
R17
R18
H10
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H9
X1
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
X1
2 4 6
1 3 5
+5.00
V3
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
4.4
X1
-5.00
X1
P.A.T. DS350
Graphic
4.5
TERMINAL BOARD
ERROR CODE 12, DRAWING #1
1.
LOWER BOOM ALL THE WAY DOWN, SHUT OFF ENGINE. DISCONNECT
HYDRAULIC HOSE FROM LIFT CYLINDER TO THE PISTON SIDE
PRESSURE TRANSDUCER SO THAT NO HYDRAULIC PRESSURE IS APPLIED
TO TRANSDUCER.
2.
H8
V2
A2B
V1
K9
SHUT
OFF
H4
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
H9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
H1
V8
V5
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
X1
R17
R18
H10
H3
V7
ROD
DRAIN
4 - WAY
V9
X1
X1
V3
H2
V6
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
INNER
MID
H5
X1
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
F1
2 4 6
1 3 5
.000
X1
R2
4.6
R1
4.7
TERMINAL BOARD
ERROR CODE 12, DRAWING #3
5.
6.
H8
V2
A2B
V1
K9
SHUT
OFF
H4
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
H9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
H1
V8
V5
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
X1
DISCONNECT
FROM X1 - 21
R17
R18
H10
H3
V7
ROD
DRAIN
4 - WAY
V9
X1
JUMPER
WIRE
X1
V3
H2
V6
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
INNER
MID
H5
X1
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
F1
2 4 6
1 3 5
X1
R2
4.8
R1
C
B
A D
4.9
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
DS350 Graphic
Rod Pressure
Transducer to C.P.U.
Connections
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
14
o o
o o
13
PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
ROD SIDE
DAVS
4
3
2
1
4.10
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
o
o30
o
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
4.11
0
145
290
435
580
725
870
1015
1160
1305
1450
1595
1740
1885
2030
2175
2320
2465
2610
2755
2900
3045
3190
3335
3480
3625
3770
3915
4060
4205
4350
PRESSURE
(P.S.I.)
"INPUT" SIGNAL AT
TERM. X1-16 IN
CENTRAL UNIT
0 MV.
-33.3 MV.
-66.6 MV.
-99.9 MV.
-133.3 MV.
-166.6 MV.
-199.9 MV.
-233.2 MV.
-266.6 MV.
-299.9 MV.
-333.2 MV.
-366.5 MV.
-399.9 MV.
-433.2 MV.
-466.5 MV.
-499.8 MV.
-533.1 MV.
-566.5 MV.
-599.8 MV.
-633.1 MV.
-666.4 MV.
-699.7 MV.
-733.1 MV.
-766.4 MV.
-799.7 MV.
-833.1 MV.
-866.3 MV.
-899.7 MV.
-932.9 MV.
-966.3 MV.
-999.9 MV.
CHANNEL # 3
"OUTPUT" SIGNAL AT MP 5
TEST POINT ON MAIN
BOARD IN C.U.
0.5 V.
0.63 V.
0.77 V.
0.89 V.
1.03 V.
1.17 V.
1.29 V.
1.43 V.
1.53 V.
1.69 V.
1.83 V.
1.97 V.
2.09 V.
2.23 V.
2.36 V.
2.49 V.
2.63 V.
2.76 V.
2.89 V.
3.03 V.
3.16 V.
3.29 V.
3.43 V.
3.56 V.
3.69 V.
3.83 V.
3.96 V.
4.09 V.
4.23 V.
4.36 V.
4.50 V.
4.12
DAVS 301
PRESSURE TRANSDUCER
(ROD SIDE)
TEST POINT
ON MAIN BOARD
WIRE NUMBER
CENTRAL UNIT
TERMINAL BOARD
PRESSURE
FROM ROD SIDE
OF LIFT CYLINDERS
X1
D
C
B
13
X1
14
15
16
AMP
P5
0.0V
(GND)
- 5.0V
TO A/D
CONVERTER
5.0V
MP 5 VOLTAGES
MP 5
TEST POINT
E 23
4.50V MAX.
.500V MIN.
ERROR
CODE
WORKING
RANGE
E 13
.0V
ERROR
CODE
P5 ZERO POINT
ADJUSTMENT
+ 5.0V
OUTPUT SIGNAL :
ZERO PRESSURE = 0.000V
MAX. PRESSURE = -1.0V
(+ / - 25 MV)
X1
CH. #3
OPERATING
WINDOW
-5.00
H8
V2
H4
V1
A2B K9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
SHUT
OFF
H1
V5
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
V8
R17
R18
H10
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H9
X1
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
X1
2 4 6
1 3 5
+5.00
V3
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
4.13
X1
X1
P.A.T. DS350
Graphic
4.14
TERMINAL BOARD
ERROR CODE 13, DRAWING #1
1.
LOWER BOOM ALL THE WAY DOWN, SHUT OFF ENGINE. DISCONNECT
HYDRAULIC HOSE FROM LIFT CYLINDER TO THE ROD SIDE
PRESSURE TRANSDUCER SO THAT NO HYDRAULIC PRESSURE IS APPLIED
TO TRANSDUCER.
2.
2 4 6
1 3 5
X1
H8
V2
A2B
V1
K9
SHUT
OFF
H4
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
H1
V8
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
V5
R17
R18
H10
H3
.000
X1
V3
H2
V6
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
INNER
MID
V7
ROD
DRAIN
4 - WAY
V9
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H9
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
H5
X1
R2
4.15
R1
4.16
TERMINAL BOARD
ERROR CODE 13, DRAWING #3
5.
6.
A2B
V1
K9
SHUT
OFF
H4
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
H1
V8
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
V5
H10
H3
V3
H2
V6
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
INNER
MID
V7
ROD
DRAIN
4 - WAY
V9
X1
JUMPER
WIRE X1
R17
R18
H5
X1
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
H8
V2
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
H9
DISCONNECT
X1
FROM X1 - 16
2 4 6
1 3 5
F1
X1
R2
4.17
R1
C
B
A D
4.18
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 5
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
DS350 Graphic
Boom Angle to C.P.U.
Connections
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
14
o o
o o
13
CABLE REEL
17
R.F.
FILTERS
18
10
9
8
7
A
B
1
2
5
4
1 2 3
3
4
2
LG
4.7K
CORE
WG
6
SHIELD
2
1
3
2
4
1
5.1
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
DE 6
LENGTH
RESET SW.
DE 5
CM / IM
RET. SW.
DE 4
OM / FLY
RET. / % SW.
-5V
-SIG
GND
86
K7 = OM / FLY
- 2 WAY
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F8
86
o
o30
o
K6 = CM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F7
86
o
30
o o
K5 = 4 - WAY
DIREC. VALVE
87A
87
85
F6
86
o
30
o o
K4 = TELE OUT
OF SEQ.
87A
87
85
F5
86
o
30
o o
K3 = ROD
DRAIN SOL.
87A
87
85
F4
86
o
o30
o
K2 = IM 2 - WAY
87A
87
85
F3
86
o
30
o o
87A
87
85
F2
87A
87
.
.
o
30
o oK10
o o o K9
o o o K8
SIG
0-SIG
86
K10
UB
UB
DE 3
AUTO MODE
SW. ON
DE 2
PRESS. SW.
BOOM RET.
DE 1
PRESS. SW.
BOOM EXT.
0 (UB)
0 (UB)
RXD
TXD
UB
-SIG
+SIG
-SIG
0 (UB)
85
A2B
COMPARATOR
-9V
+9V
-5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND
-SIG
-5V
+5V
GND LEN.(OA)
-5V
ANGLE
GND
X4
0(UB)
+UB
4
3
2
1
)
)
)
)
0 (UB) / GND
+24 V
5.2
"OUTPUT" SIGNAL AT MP 8
TEST POINT ON MAIN
BOARD IN C.U.
+.48
+.70
+.92
+1.15
+1.37
+1.60
+1.80
+2.04
+2.26
+2.48
+2.70
+2.92
+3.15
+3.38
+3.60
+3.82
+4.04
+4.27
+4.49
90 DEGS.
85 DEGS.
80 DEGS.
75 DEGS.
70 DEGS.
65 DEGS.
60 DEGS.
55 DEGS.
50 DEGS.
45 DEGS.
40 DEGS.
35 DEGS.
30 DEGS.
25 DEGS.
20 DEGS.
15 DEGS.
10 DEGS.
5 DEGS.
0 DEGS.
ACTUAL
BOOM ANGLE
X1
TERMINAL STRIP
IN JUNCTION BOX
TEST POINT
ON MAIN BOARD
WIRE NUMBER
CENTRAL UNIT
TERMINAL BOARD
ANGLE SENSOR
0o
90o
5.3
13
FIXED
RESISTOR
X1
3 11
4 9
A 1 8
AMP
5.0V
4.50V MAX.
.500V MIN.
TO A/D
CONVERTER
MP 8
TEST POINT
E 25
WORKING
RANGE
E 15
MP 8 VOLTAGES
ERROR
CODE
ERROR
CODE
.0V
-5V
0.0V
(GND)
MAXIMUM SIGNAL
-3.125V = 0o ANGLE
MINIMUM SIGNAL
-1.875V = 90o ANGLE
FIXED
RESISTOR
X1
CH. #5
OPERATING
WINDOW
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 6
6.1
4.7K
A
B
1
2
1
2
1 2 3
3
SHIELD
LENGTH
CABLE
4
2
CORE
SHIELD
A2B
L.M.I.
CONSOLE
BYPASS KEY
BLUE
WEIGHT
ASSY
A2B
SWITCH
ASSY
18
17
7
6
+SIG
OUTPUT
1
X1
UB
+24V
86
87
K9
87A
V3
85
K8
LMI OVERLOAD
A2B
ELECTRONICS V2
6
K9
7
34 0- SIG
35
30
45
44
46
47
48
- # - WIRE NUMBER
X1
FROM
CRANE SUPPLY
+24V
X1
49
14 SOCKET
PLUG
10
14
13
F2-10A
LMI
BYPASS
KEY
(CU)
73
R.F.
FILTERS
CABLE REEL
SLIP
RINGS
3 GREY
2
2
4 VIOLET
1
3 RED
LEVER LOCKOUT
SOLENOID VALVE *
UB
+24V
K10
30
DRAWING 1:
BOOM TIP JUNCTION BOX W/VOLTMETER ON 1 & 2 TURN POWER OFF OR
DISCONNECT X1:35 ON CONNECTION BOARD IN CENTRAL UNIT.
MEASURE THE RESISTANCE BETWEEN TERMINALS 1 & 2.
A2B SWITCH CLOSED = 4700 +/- 500 OHMS
A2B SWITCH OPEN = GREATER THAN 1 MEGOHM
1
2
4.70
6.2
DRAWING 2:
TURN POWER OFF OR DISCONNECT X1:35 ON CONNECTION BOARD IN
CENTRAL UNIT. MEASURE RESISTANCE BETWEEN X2:RED & X1:BROWN.
A2B SWITCH CLOSED = 4700 (+/-500) OHMS
A2B SWITCH OPEN = GREATER THAN 1 MEGAOHM
X2 RED
SHEILD
X1 BROWN
CORE
4.70
X2 : RED
X1 : BROWN
6.3
DRAWING 3:
CABLE REEL W/VOLTMETER ON 7 & 8. TURN POWER OFF OR DISCONNECT X1:35
ON CONNECTION BOARD IN CENTRAL UNIT, MEASURE THE RESISTANCE
BETWEEN TERMINALS 7 & 8.
A2B SWITCH CLOSED = 4700 (+/- 500) OHMS
A2B SWITCH OPEN = GREATER THAN 1 MEGOHM
4.70
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112131415 16
6.4
DRAWING 4:
BOOM BASE JUNCTION BOX W/VOLTMETER ON 5 & 6 TURN POWER OFF OR
DISCONNECT X1:35 ON CONNECTION BOARD IN CENTRAL UNIT.
MEASURE THE RESISTANCE BETWEEN TERMINALS 5 & 6.
A2B SWITCH CLOSED = 4700 (+/- 500) OHMS
A2B SWITCH OPEN = GREATER THAN 1 MEGAOHM
3
4
5
6
7
6.5
4.70
DRAWING 5:
CONNECTION BOARD W/VOLTMETER ON X1:34 & X1:35
TURN POWER OFF TO CENTRAL UNIT. MEASURE THE RESISTANCE
BETWEEN X1:34 & X1:35.
A2B SWITCH CLOSED = 4700 (+/- 500) OHMS
A2B SWITCH OPEN = GREATER THAN 1 MEGOHM
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
H1
V8
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
OUTER
MID
V11
K7
R16
R9
V5
K4
K1
R10
R3
R4
R17
R18
H10
H3
R13
R11
R12
R7
V6
K3
R8
R5
F4
X1
77 76 75
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
R2
R6
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
IM
RO
F5
F6
X1
80 79 78
V3
R1
49 48 47
SE
70 69 68
F7
K5
4W
4.70
R14
CM
OM
F8
K6
V7
ROD
DRAIN
X4
V9
4 - WAY
CENTER
MID
V10
X1
H2
INNER
MID
H5
H6
X1
71 72 73 74
A2B K9
SHUT
OFF
H4
R15
V1
X1
X1
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
H8
V2
H7
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
H9
X3
X1
2 4 6
1 2 3 4
1 3 5
X4
F3
F2
59 58 57 56 55 54 53
X1
52 51 50
X1
43 42 41
40 39 38
X1
37 36
35 34 33 32 31 30
46 45 44
X1
6.6
DRAWING 6:
CONNECTION BOARD W/TEMPORARY 4.7k RESISTOR INSTALLED
TURN POWER OFF TO CENTRAL UNIT. INSTALL THE RESISTANCE BETWEEN
X1:34 & X1:35. TURN POWER ON TO CENTRAL UNIT AND THE A2B ALARM
SHOULD BE INACTIVE.
X3
R15
K4
R16
R9
R10
K1
R3
71 72 73 74
K7
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
A2B K9
SHUT
OFF
2 4 6
1 3 5
1 2 3 4
F1
R4
K10
K6
K5
K3
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
X4
R13
R14
R11
R12
R7
R8
R5
R2
R6
R1
49 48 47
F8
70 69 68
80 79 78
77 76 75
F7
F6
F5
F4
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
43 42 41
40 39 38
37 36
F3
F2
59 58 57 56 55 54 53
35 34 33 32 31 30
4.70k
6.7
52 51 50
46 45 44
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 7
CU
DESCRIPTION
TERMINAL
A104
TELE EXTEND (+24V)
X1/38
NOTES
GROVE PRESSURE SWITCH SIGNAL
A104
X1/40
A104
X1/42
A104
X1/76
A104
X1/78
A104
X1/80
E1
E2
E3
E4
E5
7.1
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 8
E-1
E-4
B-7
B-7
E-1
E-1
8.1
G-3
G-4
G-3
G-2
DESCRIPTION
X1 TERM.
DESCRIPTION
1,2
3,4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33,36
34
35
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50,51,52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
67
68
69
70,71,72
73
74
75
76
77
78
79
80
V1
K9
A2B
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
X3
H7
H4
H1
V8
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
OUTER
MID
V11
R15
SHUT
OFF
K7
R16
R9
V5
K4
K1
R10
R3
R4
R17
R18
H10
H6
H3
R13
R11
R12
R7
V6
K3
R8
R5
X1
77 76 75
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
R2
R6
F4
64 63 62 61 60
IM
67 66 65
F5
D
RO
F6
X1
80 79 78
V3
R1
49 48 47
Q
SE
F7
K5
4W
70 69 68
R14
CM
OM
F8
K6
V7
ROD
DRAIN
X4
V9
4 - WAY
CENTER
MID
V10
X1
H2
INNER
MID
H5
X1
71 72 73 74
H8
V2
X1
X1
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
H9
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
X1
2 4 6
1 2 3 4
1 3 5
X4
F3
F2
59 58 57 56
X1
55 54 53
52 51 50
X1
43 42 41
40 39 38
37 36 35
34 33 32 31 30
46 45 44
X1
X1
8.3
DESCRIPTION
CU
TERMINAL
NOT USED
A104
X1/52
NOTES
NONE
K2
A104
X1/54
K3
A104
X1/57
K4
A104
X1/61
K5
A104
X1/62
K5
A104
X1/63
K5
A104
X1/64
K6
A104
X1/66
K7
A104
X1/69
K8
A104
X1/44
K9
A104
X1/46
K10
A104
X1/48
K10
A104
X1/49
8.4
XD1
12 11 10
XC1
8
X1
XB1
5
XA1
2 1
X1
MP4 MP5
MP6 MP7
..
J3
..
X3
MP10
J1
X2
..
J2 3
MP3MP2 MP8
MP1
X1
F1
8.5
MP5
MP1
+5V
MP4
MP2
MP3
MP6
GND
C11 C12
MP0
H12
H11
H10
H9
H8
H7
H6
H5
H4
H3
7 8
H13
H2
H14
4 5
H15
H1
1 2 3
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
H16
1
30
25
15
20
8.6
10
Interface
connector
Description
71
51
73
387
388
239
242
243
244
[507]
[505]
[338]
323
[74]
[744]
240
147
238
1083
255
257
CRANE GND
W
X
8.7
IS
A111
1
X1
2 3
13 14 15 20 21
23 - SOCKET RECEPT
S/S HARNESS (REF)
TMS/TTS 870
INTERFACE
TELE PROP ANALOG GND
56 57 1 2 3 4 48 38 40 42 36 37 39 41 75 77 79 59 61 49 62 63 64
7 19 10 11 12
240
147
238
1083
255
257
6 9
323
To Boom Base
Junction Box
4
B
3
CM TELE
IM TELE
8 10 2 3 5 7 11 12 13 14 1
OM/FLY TELE
HIGH=AUTO / NONE=MANUAL
7 8
8.8
1
5 6
K7 (COM) +24V
68 69
GND
A113
4
X1
71
51
73
387
388
239
242
243
244
K6 (COM) +24V
K6 (NO) +24V TO CM 2-WAY SOLS
65 66
+24V
K2 (COM) +24V
K2 (NO) +24V TO IM 2-WAY SOLS
53 54
4 5 6
18
16
5
6 9 10
DI E5 GND
DI E5 (+24V=CM RET)
A114
3 4
X1
DI E3 (+24V)
[ +24=MODE A
0V=MODE B
DI E2 GND
DI E2
A1 (PROP)
AGND
GND
GND
+24V
+24V
K5 (COM)
K5 (NO) OUTPUT TO EXT PROP
K4 (COM) +24V
K4 (NC) +24V TO TELE OUT OF SEQ
DI 6 GND
DI 4 GND
DI 5 GND
DI 2 GND
DI 3 GND
DI 1 GND
DI GND
K3 (COM) +24V
+24V
IS
DI EXTENSION BOARD
24 350 300 301
9 10 11 12
7
12
9
8
17 22 23 24 25
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 9
MODEL:
S/N:
VDC
VDC
+5V @ MP 18=
+5V @ MP 12 =
+12V @ MP 21=
+ 6V @ MP 20 =
4.
5.
6.
VDC @ X1-10
VDC @ X1-10
VDC @ X1-11
VDC @ X1-9
VDC @ X1-9
VDC @ X1 -11
9.1
VDC @ MP 6
VDC @ MP 6
VDC @ MP 8
VDC @ MP 8
E-1
E-4
B-7
B-7
E-1
E-1
9.2
G-3
G-4
G-3
G-2
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 10
A. Check the zero pressure output signals for the rod and the
piston pressure transducer on the terminal board inside central
processing unit. Terminal X1/16 for rod signal and terminal
X1/21 for piston signal. Signal voltage should be .000 volt
+/- .025 volts.
B. Refer to instructions on pages 10.3 and 10.4 for adjustment of
pressure channel zero points.
If the main board is replaced, the data and system EPROM must be removed
from the old board and installed on the new board. Refer to page 10.5 for
EPROM location.
10.1
TERMINAL BOARD
V2
V1
K9
SHUT
OFF
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
H1
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
V5
R17
R18
H10
H3
V7
ROD
DRAIN
4 - WAY
V9
.000
X1
V3
H2
V6
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
INNER
MID
H5
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 71 72 73 74
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
H8
V8
2 4 6
1 3 5
H9
H4
X1
.000
F1
A2B
X1
R2
10.2
R1
10.3
10.4
10.5
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 11
GENERAL FLOWCHART
This section explains how to handle a problem that may arise with the P.A.T. Load Moment
Indicator System - P.A.T. DS350. The procedures are easy to follow and are given in
flowcharts on the following pages. Start with general flowchart below which will guide you
to one of the more detailed flowcharts shown on pages 11.2-11.40.
START
Whats Wrong?
Lever Lockout
Activated
Length Cable
Problem
Go to Page 11.2
Go to Page 11.3
Wrong Length
Displayed
Go to Page 11.10
Wrong Angle
Displayed
Go to Page 11.32
No Display
Go to Page 11.4
No Function
Anti-Two-Block
Go to Page 11.7
Wrong Load
Displayed
Interface Problem
Go to Page 11.35
Go to Pages 11. 38
Go to Page 11.40
Error Code
Displayed
Go to Page 11.41
11.1
START
fixed?
YES
NO
Does light in console indicate
Anti-Two-Block warning?
NO
YES
If console display is
blank, fault is located
in power supply,
wiring or fuses.
Fault in Anti-Two
Block system.
Go to Page 11.4
Go to Page 11.7
11.2
STEP
ACTION
Open cable reel cover and disconnect wiring from terminal block. Pull 7- conductor
cable out of strain relief.
Remove damaged length cable, which is mounted to the slip rings in the cable reel,
from Terminal X1 and X2. Refer to Drawing on Page 11.49.
Turn the cable reel and open the stain relief attached to the axle in the center of the drum.
Pull existing length cable out of the cable reel.
Disconnect damaged length cable from Anti-Two-Block switch receptacle at the boom nose.
7
Pull new length cable through the hole, pipe and strain relief and push it through the axle of
the reeling drum. Tighten strain relief to ensure sealing.
Dismantle length cable near slip ring and reconnect shield to terminal No. X2 and center to
No. X1. Refer to Drawing on Page 11.49.
Remount cable reel to the boom. Turn reeling drum clockwise to get rest of new cable
onto the drum.
10
Set preload on cable reel by turning the drum counter-clockwise (see page 2.15 - pre-tension).
11
Reconnect new cable to Terminal No. 1 (center) and ground terminal (shield) of receptacle
at the boom nose.
12
11.3
NO DISPLAY
PROBLEM
Blank console display.
No warninglight shown.
Crane movements stopped.
START
correct?
NO
Replace fuses.
YES
Measure crane voltage on terminal board (terminal block X1) between Pin 2 (+24V) and
Pin 4 (ground). Refer to Drawing 3,
Terminal Board, on page 11.50.
Note: If crane voltage is measured below 18V
system will switch off.
correct?
NO
YES
Measure crane voltage on terminal board (terminal block X4) between Pin 2 (+24V) and
Pin 3 (ground). Refer to Drawing 3,
Terminal Board, on page 11.50.
correct?
NO
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.4
NO DISPLAY
continued
PREVIOUS PAGE
correct?
NO
YES
correct?
NO
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.5
NO DISPLAY
continued
PREVIOUS PAGE
correct?
NO
YES
correct?
NO
YES
END
11.6
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PROBLEM
Function of Anti-Two-Block System is faulty.
START
Check to see whether or not crane is in two-block condition.
NO
Lower hook down in safe position.
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
Remove jumper / dummy plug and check
function of anti-two-block switch with
ohmmeter between terminals 1 and 2
in the receptacle.Switch closed=4700 + 500 Ohms
(weight installed) Switch open => 1 Megaohm
(weight removed)
Safe Condition = 0 ohm
Block-To-Block = > 1 megaohm
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.7
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.8
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
END
11.9
Is the
percentage reading
(1%, 0%, 0%)?
Yes
No
Continue to Page 11.15
Is the
Voltage
Correct?
No
Yes
Keep the inner mid section retracted.
Measure the inner mid reset switch signal
at terminal 3 (24V) and 5 (GND) in the
junction box at the front of the boom base
section.
Next Page
11.10
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Is the
Voltage
Correct ?
No
Yes
Measure the IM reset switch signal at
terminal 15 (24V) and 14 (GND) in the
boom base junction box.
Is the
voltage
correct?
No
Yes
Is the
voltage
correct?
No
Yes
Measure the CM reset switch signal at
terminal 10 (24V) and 9 (GND) in the length
sensor LG221.
Next Page
11.11
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Measure the CM reset switch signal at
terminal 30 (24V) and 14 (GND) in the
boom base junction box.
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Measure the CM reset switch signal at
central unit terminal Al14-9 (24V) and
A l04-36 (GND).
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Measure voltage supply to OM switch at
terminal 11 (+24V) and 9 (GND) in the center
mid junction box.
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Measure voltage supply to CM switch at
terminal 7 (+24V) and 5 (GND) in the inner
mid junction box.
Next Page
11.12
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Keep the outer mid (OM) section retracted.
Measure the OM reset switch signal at terminal
10 (24V) and 9 (GND) in the center mid junction
box .
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Measure the CM reset switch signal at
terminal 10 (24V) and 9 (GND) in the
length- angle sensor LWG221.
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Next Page
11.13
Is the
voltage
correct ?
No
Yes
Measure the OM reset switch signal at
central unit terminal Al04-78 (24V) and
Al04-36 (GND).
Is the
voltage
correct ?
11.14
Is the
main boom length
indicated correctly?
Yes
No
CAUTION: High tension on cable reel drum!
CAUTION: To avoid length potentiometer damage. do not
turn the length potentiometer past the stop.
Is the
length cable
spooled properly on
the LG 208
drum ?
Continue
with *
on page 11.17
No
Yes
With all sections completely
retracted, un-spool the length
cable carefully. Let the drum
rewind slowly and spool the
cable manually back on the
drum. Check the roller guides
for correct adjustment.
Has
the adjustment
corrected the boom length
indication.
Yes
Continue
with *
on page 11.17.
No
Next Page
11.15
Is the voltage
correct (-5V) ?
No
Yes
Is the voltage
correct (-5V) ?
No
Yes
Is the voltage
correct ?
(-500mV)
No
Yes
Check the length signal in the central unit.
Measure the signal at central unit terminal
A104 Xl/10(-5OOmV) and Al 04 Xl/8(GND)
with fully retracted boom.
Next Page
11.16
Previous Page
Is the voltage
correct ?
(-500mV)
Yes
No
Check the wiring that connects the
LG 208 with the central unit. Inspect the
cable and connectors.
Have you
found any wiring
faults ?
Yes
No
Connect the voltmeter central unit
terminal A104 X1/10 (signal) and
A104 Xl/8 (GND). Use a small
screwdriver to turn the length
potentiometer carefully clockwise.
The voltage should decrease
from -500mV to -4.5V.
Is the voltage
decreasing from
-500mV to
-4.5V ?
Yes
No
Check the wiring that connects the
LG 208 with the central unit. Inspect the
cable and connectors.
Next Page
11.17
Previous Page
Have you
found any wiring
faults ?
Yes
No
Connect the voltmeter central unit
terminal 2 (signal) and terminal
1 (GND). Use a small in the
cable reel. Carefully turn the length
potentiometer clockwise.
The voltage should decrease
from -500mV to -4.5V.
Is the
voltage correct?
(0 turns = -500mV
10 turns = -4.5 V)
Yes
No
11.18
Is the
inner mid boom length Yes
indicated correctly?
Continue
with *
CAUTION : High tension on cable reel drum ! on page 11.21
CAUTION : To avoid length potentiometer damage,
do not turn the length potentiometer past the stop.
No
Is the
length cable
spooled properly on
the 221
drum?
No
Yes
Reset the length potentiometer.
Has
the adjustment
corrected the inner mid
length indication?
Continue
with *
on page 11.21
Check the power supply to the length sensor. Measure
the power supply voltage at central unit terminal A104
X1/11 (-5V) and A104 X1/8 (GND)
Next Page
11.19
Is the voltage
correct (-5V)?
No
Yes
Possible short or wiring fault between
central unit and cable reel. Measure with
the DVM at the length transducers (LG 221)
terminal 1 (GND) and 3 (-5V)
Is the voltage
correct (-5V)?
No
Yes
Faulty wiring between
central unit and length
transducer. Check
wiring, junction boxes
and connectors for
faulty wiring.
Is the voltage
correct (-500mV)?
No
Yes
Check the length signal in the central unit.
Measure the signal at central unit terminal
A104 X1-24 (-500mV) and A104 X1-8
(GND) with fully retracted boom.
Next Page
11.20
Is the voltage
correct (-500mV)?
Yes
No
Check the wiring that connects the
LG 221 with the central unit. Inspect the
cable and the connections.
Yes
No
Connect the voltmeter to central unit
terminal A104 X1-24 (signal) and
A104 X1-8 (GND).
Turn potentiometer clockwise
0 turns = -500mV, 10 turns = -4.5V.
*
Is
the voltage
decreasing from
-500mV to
- 4.5V?
Yes
No
Check the wiring between length
transducer LG 221 and central unit
Inspect cable connectors and junction
boxes.
Next Page
11.21
Yes
No
Connect the voltmeter to terminal 2 (signal)
and terminal 1 (GNU) in the cable reel.
Turn length potentiometer clockwise.
0 turns = - 500mV, 10 turns = -4.5V
Is the
voltage correct?
0 turns = -500mV
10 turns = - 4.5V
Yes
No
Reset length
transducer. Possible main board defect.
11.22
Is the
center mid
length indicated
correctly?
Yes
Continue
with *
on page 11.25
No
Yes
Has
the adjustment
corrected the center mid
length indication?
Yes
Continue
with *
on page 11.25
No
Next Page
11.23
Is the voltage
correct (-5V)?
No
Yes
Possible short or wiring fault between
central unit and cable reel. Measure at
the length transducer, terminal 1
(GND) and 3 (-5V).
Is the voltage
correct (-5V)?
No
Yes
Verify the length sensor signal.
Measure the voltage at the length
transducer, terminal 1 (GND)
and 2 (-500mV) with fully
retracted boom.
Is the voltage
correct (-500mV)?
No
Yes
Measure the signal at central unit terminal
A 104 X1-73 (-500mV) and A 104 X1-8
(GND) with fully retracted boom.
Next Page
11.24
Is the voltage
correct (-500mV)?
Yes
No
Check the wiring that connects the
LG 221 with the central unit. Inspect the
cable and the connections.
Yes
No
*
Is
the voltage
decreasing from
-500mV to
-4.5V?
Yes
No
Check the wiring that connects the
LG 221 with the central unit. Inspect the
cable and the connections.
Next Page
11.25
Yes
No
Is the
voltage correct?
0 turns = -500mV
10 turns = - 4.5V
Yes
No
11.26
Does the
boom extend or
retract?
No
Yes
Switch to automode. Start the engine and operate the
extend control. Measure the voltage at central unit
terminal A 104 X1-38 (24V) and A 104 X1-37 (GND)
while operating the extend control.
Is the
voltage
correct?
No
Yes
Switch to automode. Start the engine and operate the
retract control. Measure the voltage at central unit
terminal A 104 X1-40 (24V) and A 104 X1-39 (GND)
while operating the extend control.
Is the
voltage
correct?
No
Yes
Select the service screen on the console
by pressing the two outer keys (F1 & F4)
simultaneously. The ramping value for the selected
section shall increase from 0 to 255. The ramping
value remains 0 in the neutral position.
Next Page
11.27
Is the
ramping value
increasing?
No
Yes
Continue to troubleshoot the wiring to
the 2 way value and the hydraulic
circuit.
11.28
Follow instructions in
section A.
Is the
problem
corrected?
Yes
End
No
Follow instructions in
section B.
Is the
problem
corrected?
Yes
End
No
Follow instructions in
section C.
Is the
problem
corrected?
Yes
End
No
Follow instructions in
section D.
Is the
problem
corrected?
No
Yes
End
Next Page
11.29
Is the
switch and
target adjusted
correctly?
No
Yes
Measure the switch signal
at central unit.
A 104 X1-76 (24V) and
A 104 X1-36 (GND)
Is the
voltage
correct?
Adjust OM retract
switch and target.
Yes
No
Have you
found a
fault in
the wiring?
No
Next Page
Yes
11.30
Is the
voltage
correct?
Yes
No
Check the signal at terminal 10 (24V) and
9 (GND) in CM junction box. Refer to
section 9.1 and 11.
Is the
voltage
correct?
No
Yes
Retract all boom section in
manual mode and let the system
reset boom percentage.
Recheck.
End
11.31
START
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.32
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.33
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
END
11.34
NO
correct?
YES
Check boom length reading on display.
NO
correct?
YES
Measure radius and check with the
displayed radius.
NO
correct?
YES
Check power supply to pressure transducer (rod
side). Unplug transducer cable from transducer.
Measure on terminal board at terminal block X1.
Measure between Pin 14 (ground) and Pin 15
(-5V). Measure between Pin 14 (ground) and Pin
13 (+5V).
Power supply on main board defected. Check
power supply out and measure between test
point MP15 = ground and MP18 = +5V and
between test point MP15 = ground and MP2 =
-5V. If incorrect, replace main board and reset
pressure channel.
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.35
NO
correct?
YES
Check power supply at transducer plugs. Measure between B = ground and A = +5V. Measure between B = ground and C = -5V.
NO
correct?
YES
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.36
NO
correct?
YES
Reconnect wire # 4 from transducer cables
back to terminal X1, Pin 16 (rod side) and
terminal X1, Pin 21 (piston side).
Without pressure in hoses, check 0 point
adjustment on main board by disconnecting
hydraulic hoses from transducer. Measure
between test point MP 15 (ground) and test
point MP 4. Signal should be 0.50V
(piston side). Measure between test point
MP 15 (ground) and test point MP 5. Signal
should be 0.50V (rod side).
NO
correct?
YES
END
11.37
START
NO
Place EPROM in correct socket.
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
11.38
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
Ensure that wires are properly connected between terminal block X1 Pin 31 and console
terminal Pin 4 and between terminal block X1
Pin 32 and console terminal Pin 3.
NO
correct?
YES
END
11.39
INTERFERENCE PROBLEM
PROBLEM
Interference from crane electric.
Error Code E93 / E94 intermittent.
Frozen console displays.
START
Check system out; Pg. 11.38&39 - Bad Data
Transfer Between Console & Central Unit.
NO
Replace or repair part which is defective.
correct?
YES
Check if additional ground like between main
board terminal X9 and central unit box mounting
bracket is in place.
NO
correct?
YES
Ensure that cable shields are connected correctly.
Refer to connections and wiring diagrams.
NO
correct?
YES
Find out which component of the crane electric
is spiking out (e.g. dump valve, outrigger relay).
Install a diode or varistor across terminals of
spiking component. Diode type such as 1N 4001
can be used (watch + and - connection for diode).
END
11.40
PROBLEM
Error code displayed. Lever lockout activated.
Warning lights on.
ERROR
DISPLAY
ERROR
CAUSE
ACTION
E 01*
E 02*
E 03*
E 04*
E 05*
E 06*
11.41
ERROR
CAUSE
ACTION
E 07
No acknowledgment signal
from overload relay (K8).
Replace relay.
E 08
No acknowledgment signal
from Anti-Two-Block switch
relay (K9).
Replace relay.
E 11
E 12
E 13
E 14
Pressure transducer on
piston side defective.
Electronic component in
the measuring channel defective
on main board.
11.42
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 15
E 16
ERROR
Fallen below lower limiting
value for the measuring
channel "angle main boom".
CAUSE
ACTION
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
See Section 5.
E 18
E 19
Electronic component on
the main board defective.
+5 volt supply
E 20
E 21
11.43
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 22
E 23
E 24
E 25
E 26
ERROR
Upper limiting value for the
measuring channel "pressure
piston side exceeded.
CAUSE
ACTION
11.44
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
See Section 5.
Replace angle sensor and reset
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
See Section 10.
See Error E 16.
ERROR
Error in the reference
voltage.
-5 volt supply
E 31
E 37
CAUSE
Supply and Reference voltages on
MP10 is more than 3.3V
Electronic component on
the main board defective.
ACTION
Check supply voltages.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
See section 10.
Replace EPROM with system
program.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
See section 10.
Replace system program
EPROM.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
See section10.
E 38
E 41
E 42
Internal defect in
digital part of CPU.
E 45
Error in internal
communications.
Defective electronic
component.
E 47
Malfunction in the
monitored write/read
memory.
Internal defect in
in digital part of CPU
E 48
E 51
11.45
ERROR
DISPLAY
ERROR
CAUSE
ACTION
E 60
Error in EPROM
E 70
E 71
E 72 E 77
E 80
E 83
11.46
ERROR
CAUSE
ACTION
E 89
E 91
Interruption or accidental
ground in the line from
console electronics to
central unit.
E 92
E 93
E 94
Interruption or accidental
ground in the data line from
central unit to console.
Electromagnetic interferences
(e.g. when switching
contactors or valves).
11.47
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 95
ERROR
Error in the crane data EPROM
CAUSE
ACTION
E 96
E 97
E 98
11.48
X2 : RED
X1 : BROWN
11.49
X3
H7
A2B K9
LMI K8
SHUT
OFF
SHUT
OFF
H4
H1
V8
OUT OF
SEQUENCE
OUTER
MID
V11
R15
V1
K7
R16
R9
V5
K4
K1
R10
R3
R4
R17
R18
H10
H3
R13
R14
R11
R12
K3
R8
R5
K10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K2
R2
R6
F4
67 66 65 64 63 62 61 60
IM
X1
77 76 75
V6
D
RO
F5
X1
80 79 78
V3
R1
49 48 47
Q
F6
R7
SE
F7
K5
4W
70 69 68
CM
OM
F8
V7
ROD
DRAIN
K6
4 - WAY
X4
V9
CENTER
MID
V10
X1
H2
INNER
MID
H5
H6
X1
71 72 73 74
H8
V2
X1
X1
8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28
H9
7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29
F1
X1
2 4 6
1 2 3 4
1 3 5
X4
F3
F2
59 58 57 56 55 54 53
X1
52 51 50
X1
43 42 41
40 39 38
X1
37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30
46 45 44
X1
11.50
E-1
E-4
B-7
B-7
E-1
E-1
11.51
G-3
G-4
G-3
G-2
MP 2
+7V
MP 5
+5V
MP 0
GND
MP 3
-24V
MP 4
-24V
MP 6
MP 7
MP 1
+UB
J2
J5
J1
J4
J3
X1
X5 1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
11. 52
PAT
PAT
1
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112 131415 16
11.53
COMPONENT
CAUSING
INTERFERENCE
+
SUPPRESSOR DIODE
FUSE (10A)
FUSE (2A)
OVERRIDE
KEY SWITCH
(BOTTOM VIEW
OF C.P.U.)
11.54
NORMAL
OPERATION
OUT
L/O
OVERRIDE
IN
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 11
APPENDIX
5 Section Boom
Problem :
Outer Mid section and Fly will not extend.
Reason:
Center Mid section indicates 96% - 97% extention on the PAT even though boom Section is fully
extended.
Findings:
Cable reels are spooling properly.
Switch to manual mode and retract all sections with the boom stop pulled.
Boom percentages should indicate a 0% - 0% - 0%
If not check the proximity switches
Proximity switches are all four being made when boom is fully retracted to reset zero point with
swingaway stop pulled down.
Proxy switch
Terminal to check in reference to Ground( X1/ 36)
OM/Fly Retracted
A 104 X 1/76
CM Retracted
A 114 X 1/9
IM+CM Retracted
A 104 X 1/78
The red LED will be illuminated
when switch is on.
IM % Reset
A 104 X 1/80
All four should have a minimum of
20 volts
If still not correct
Reset the length potentiometers by turning them counterclockwise until they stop with the boom fully
retracted.
If still not correct
Press the outer two keys simultaneously ( F1& F4 on the PAT console) to obtain the length indication for
the inner mid and center mid.
With the boom stop disengaged the total length retracted should be 35.4 and extended 137.8
With the inner mid extended it should read 61.0
With the inner mid and the center mid extended it should read 86.6
If still not correct
Check the voltage on terminal #6, #7 and #9 on the main board for .495 to .500 volts with the boom fully
retracted. If off, reset per the calibration papers inside the box.
Ch. #3 - Force transducer not used
Ch. #4 - Rod transducer - Do not touch
Ch. #5 - Piston transducer-Do not touch
Ch. #6 - Total Overall Length - (top reel)
Ch. #7 - Center mid / Inner mid - (middle reel)
Ch. #8 - Angle transducer - Do not touch
Ch. #9 - Inner mid - Bottom reel
Appendix 1
On the horizontal line of the graphic console press the two outer keys simultaneous to obtain the length
indication for IM and CM in a test picture.
With the boom stop disengaged calibrate the total length to retracted 35.4 and extended 137.8. Read the
boom length on the graphic console.
With the boom stop disengaged calibrate the IM length to retracted 35.4 and extended 61.0. Read the
boom length on the graphic console in the test picture.
With the boom stop disengaged calibrate the IM + CM length to retracted 35.4 and .extended 86.6. Read
the boom length on the graphic console.
Transfer data into Eprom and check out length indication as described above.
Repeat test A.
Appendix 2
OM / Fly retract
CM retract
IM + CM retract
IM % reset
A104 X 1 / 76
A l 14 X 1 / 9
A 104 X 1 / 78
A 104 X1 / 80
Once identified which circuit is not powered use the wiring diagram to locate the wiring problem.
Note: With the boom stop engaged and the IM reset switch signal on the system is programmed to
indicate 1 % extension for the IM section. To read 0 % you must pull the boom stop down and pass the
target.
The IM reset target must be adjusted with the boom stop engaged and the boom fully retracted onto the
boom stop. The IM + CM retract switch has two targets providing the boom is equipped with boom stop
retracted against boom stop and another target for retracted against base section. Do not attempt to adjust
targets if the two positions are not met. Incorrect adjustment could cause cylinder damage.
D. Boom does not extend or retract while Auto mode is selected.
Switch to manual mode and retract the boom.
When fully retracted select a legal operating mode on graphic console.
Switch to auto mode and to mode A or B.
Ensure that no other LMI error, A2B or overload exists.
Have the operator start the engine and push the extend control.
Measure extend pressure switch signal on terminal A 104 Xl / 38 in the CU ( approx. 24 Volt reference
crane GND ).
Appendix 3
If not use the electrical diagram to identify the cause. Measure signal of pressure switch
located on the right, inside the valve bank compartment. Disconnect wire 387 from the switch and
measure voltage on switch output terminal.
Have the operator start the engine and push the retract control.
Measure retract pressure switch signal on terminal A l 04 Xl / 40 in the CU
( approx. 24 Volt reference crane GND ).
If not, use the electrical diagram to identify the cause. Measure signal of pressure switch located on the
control valve. Disconnect wire 388 from switch and measure voltage on switch output terminal.
Replace switch or rectify the wiring problem.
If signals are correct and problem is not resolved go to E.
Appendix 4
Switch to mode A and measure crane voltage 24 Volt on terminal Al 14 -Xl / 3 ( DI extension board ) .
Switch to mode B and measure no crane voltage on terminal Al 14 - Xl / 3 ( DI extension board ).
Start the engine and have the operator slowly push the tele out controls. Carry out the following test.
Be sure: boom is fully retracted and B mode selected.
A 104 X1 / 54 = NO VOLTAGE
A 104 X1 / 66 = 24 VOLT
A 104 X1 / 69 = 24 VOLT
When the IM has reached 50% the system switches to extend the CM.
Measure:
A104 Xl / 54 = 24 Volt
A104 Xl / 66 = NO VOLTAGE
A104 Xl / 69 = 24 Volt
When the IM and the CM have reached 100 % the system switches to extend the OM / Fly, Measure:
A104 X1 / 54 = 24 Volt
A104 X1 / 66 = 24 Volt
A104 X1 / 69 = NO VOLTAGE
If one of above measurements is incorrect check the fuses F3, F7, F8 for relay contacts K2, K6, K7
on the terminal board.
Check relay K2, K6, K7.
Connect an Amp meter in series with wire 20 and terminal Al 04 Xl / 63. When extending the boom in
Auto mode the ramping value should climb up to a 800 mA with fully open solenoid valve.
Connect an Amp meter in series with wire 21 and terminal Al 04 Xl / 64. When retracting the boom in
Auto mode the ramping value should climb up to a 800 mA with fully open solenoid valve.
If one of above fails check fuse F6 and relay K5 on the terminal board inside CU.
Connect an Amp meter in series with the black wire removed from terminal A111 X1 / 6 and
terminal A111 X1 / 6. When extending or retracting ( depends on the direction controlled by the
operator) the boom in Auto mode the ramping value should climb up to a 800 mA with fully open
solenoid valve.
Should the measurement fail check for complete solenoid circuit - Check solenoid coil resistance for
continuity. Check for good analog ground from A111 board to solenoid. Connect Ohm meter to the
removed wire ends of terminal A111 Xl / 5 and 6 and test closed circuit. Note that you will not measure
any electrical current when the circuit is interrupted.
Rectify wiring or solenoid coil failure and test again.
Appendix 5
Appendix 6
Test Procedure
PAT DS350 Boom Control System
RT865BXL, TMS / TTS870 With 5 Section Boom
A. Purpose:
This procedure is designed to be an aid in verifying the operation and defining the proper test methods for
the wiring and control circuitry of the PAT DS350 Boom Control System.
B. Personnel required to perform these tests:
2
C. Equipment and Tools required to perform these tests:
a. Digital multimeter
b. Central unit key
c. Medium flat blade screwdriver
d. Medium philips screwdriver
e. 10mm socket or nut driver
f. Small flat blade screwdriver
D. Sub Assembly Description:
Reference Number
a. A104
b. A111
c. A114
Description
Extension Board
Analog Control Board
Digital Extension Board
2. The SUT senses that the foot pedal has been depressed by the output of a pressure switch. There are two
( 2 ) pressure switchs built into the foot pedal circuitry, one is for boom extend and the other is for boom
retract operations. The output of these switches are piped into the SUT as digital inputs. These switches
are normally open and switch crane voltage ( 24V ) on or off. Assuming that an extend operation is being
performed, A104 - X1 - P38 ( DI - 1 ) will go high and A104 - X1 - P39 ( DI - 2 ) will be low.
3. Once DI - 1 is detected, the A104 relay K - 5 is energized applying a veritable voltage signal onto
X1 - P63. This analog control is generated from the A114 board, A114 - X1 - P6, and is a variable voltage
output that is determined by a digital code supplied by the microprocessor. This code is determined by the
position of each section of the boom and the mode of operation.
4. There are three ( 3 ) control signals that are supplied by the SUT that determine which section of the
boom will be selected. The logic of these signals are such that to select a section the signal level to that
sections control valves must go low. Each section has two ( 2 ) control valves, for a total of six ( 6 ) that
must be de - energized in tandem. One valve is pilot pressure and the other is the main flow valve. The
SUT supplies control from the following terminals:
Inner Mid ( IM )
Center Mid ( CM )
Outer Mid / Fly ( OM/F
If no boom operations are selected, all of these signals will be low, but whenever an extend / retract
operation is selected, these signals become active and control the flow of hydraulic oil. The logic table for
these valves is as follows:
A104 - X1 - P54
A104 - X1 - P66
A104 - X1 - P69
IM
CM
OM /F
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
IM %
0
0
0
100
0
50
50
75
75
100
100
100
CM %
0
100
100
100
0
0
50
50
75
75
100
100
OM / Fly %
0
0
100
100
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
100
7. During the retract sequence, the operation is the same with the exception of the presence of the
proximity switches. These switches are used to detect when the applicable boom section is fully retracted.
If the OM / Fly section is being retracted, the OM / Fly switch must turn on or an E - 83 error will appear.
This will not lock out the system but will make the telescope out of sequence light to illuminate. If the
CM is being retracted, the CM switch must turn on when fully retracted before the IM will start to retract.
If this fails to happen, the IM will not retract and the telescope out of sequence light will illuminate.
Testing of these switches will be detailed in the test section.
F. Preliminary Adjustments
1. Using the 10 mm nutdriver, remove the lids from each of the cable reels.
2. Verify that all boom sections are fully retracted and that the stop block is disengaged.
3. Preset each of the length sensors to the minimum by turning the slot in the gear wheel fully
counter clockwise until it comes to a soft stop.
G. Testing the SUT:
1. Start the crane.
2. Program the PAT console to the correct operating mode.
3. Place the Auto / Manual switch in the Manual position.
OK_______ 1. Verify that the maximum load on the console is approximately 2000 lb.
OK_______ 2. Place the boom select switch into the IM position, verify that the IM lamp illuminates.
OK_______ 3. Extend the IM about 2 ft. to verify that the IM does extend, then completely retract the IM.
OK_______ 4. Place the boom select switch into the CM position, verify that the CM lamp illuminates.
OK_______ 5. Extend the CM about 2 ft. to verify that the CM does extend, then completely retract the
CM.
Appendix 9
OK_______ 6. Place the boom select switch into the OM / Fly position, verify that the OM / Fly lamp
illuminates.
OK_______ 7. Extend the OM / Fly about 2 ft. to verify that the OM / Fly does extend, then completely
retract the OM / Fly.
4. Open the central unit and the boom base junction box.
OK_______ 8. Verify that wires 11 and 12 from the 19 pin cannon plug are wired to pins L and M.
OK_______ 9. Using the meter, monitor the Manual / Auto input signal on A104 - X1 - P42, using the
chassie as ground. Verify that the signal level in Manual mode is low and high in Auto
mode.
OK_______ 10. Using the meter, monitor the telescope extend pressure switch input, A104 - X1 - P38.
Extend the boom to verify that the signal goes high.
OK_______ 11. Using the meter, monitor the telescope retract pressure switch input, A104 - X1 - P39.
Retract the boom with the stop block engaged to verify the signal goes high.
OK_______ 12. Select Auto mode and monitor the input at A114 - X1 - P3 to verify that the signal goes
high when in the A code, and low in the B code.
OK_______ 13. Select Auto mode A, and monitor the extend analog voltage control signal,
A104 - X1 - P63, Extend the boom to verify that the signal goes to a higher level, around
25 volts. Retract the boom with the stop block engaged.
OK_______17. Select Manual mode, and ensure the boom is fully retracted with the stop block
disengaged. Verify that the boom is fully retracted onto the base section.
OK_______ 18. Using the meter, monitor the signal from proximity switch 1, OM / Fly retract signal on
A104 - X1 - P76 and verify a high signal.
OK_______ 19. Using the meter, monitor the signal from proximity switch 2, CM / IM retract signal on
A104 - X1 - P78 and verify a high signal.
OK_______ 20. Using the meter, monitor the signal from proximity switch 3, length reset signal on
A104 - X1 - P80 and verify a low signal.
OK_______ 21. Using the meter, monitor the signal from proximity switch 4, CM retract signal on
A114 - X1 - P9 and verify a high signal and H5 LED is illuminated.
5. Extend all boom sections about 5 ft.
OK_______ 22. Using the meter, monitor each proximity switch signal, each should be low.
OK_______ 23. Using the meter, monitor the OM / Fly proximity retract switch input signal on
A104 - X1 - P76. While retracting the OM / Fly verify the signal changes from low to
high, until the sections bottoms out.
OK_______ 24. Using the meter, monitor the CM proximity retract switch input signal on
A114 - X1 - P3. While retracting the CM verify the signal changes from low to high,
until the section bottoms out.
OK_______ 25. Using the meter, monitor the CM / IM proximity retract switch input signal on
A104 - X1 - P78. While retracting the CM - IM verify the signal changes from low to
high, until section bottoms out.
OK_______ 26. Using the meter, monitor the length reset proximity switch signal on A104 - X1 - P80 to
verify the signal is high.
OK_______ 27. Fully retract all boom sections and switch to Auto mode. Using the meter, monitor the
telescope out of sequence signal on A104 - X1 - P61 to verify the signal is low.
OK_______ 28. Telescope the boom out approximately 5 ft. in mode B. Switch to Manual mode and
telescope the CM out about 5 ft. Switch to Auto mode and verify the signal level on
A104 - X1 - P81 is high and the telescope out of sequence light is illuminated.
OK_______ 29. Using the meter, monitor the front outrigger overload signal on A111 - X1 - P6. During
normal operation, this should stay high. Disconnect wire17 from from this terminal.
Install a jumper wire from ground, A111 - X1 - P4, to the front outrigger overload input
signal, A111 - X1 - P6. Verify that the console displays E - 18 error code. Remove the
jumper wire and install wire 17 to A111 - X1 - P6.
Appendix 11
OK_______ 30. Fully retract all boom sections and select Auto mode. Using the meter, monitor the
telescope rod drain signal on A104 - X1 - P57 and verify the signal is low.
OK_______ 31. While telescoping out, monitor the signal on A104 - X1 - P57 to verify the signal stays
low.
OK______ 32. While monitoring the telescope rod drain signal on A104 - X1 - P57, stop extending the
boom at about 5 ft., when the extend operation stops and boom comes to a rest, verify
that the signal goes high.
NOTE:
Ensure that all safety precautions are performed
before performing the following steps. Ensure that the
outriggers are fully extended and jacks are down, and
properly set.
OK_______ 33. Fully retract all boom sections with the boom stop block engaged. Select Auto mode A
and raise the boom to approximately 60 degrees.
OK_______ 34. Fully extend the boom and verify that each section sequence as listed on the attached
sheet.
OK_______ 35. Retract the boom and verify the sequence is the inverse of extend.
OK_______ 36. Fully retract all boom sections with the boom stop block engaged. Select Auto mode B
and raise the boom to approximately 60 degrees.
OK_______ 37. Retract the boom and verify the sequence is the inverse of extend.
G. Final
If all these tests pass, the system is operational and ready for calibration. Provide the crane model number,
serial number, the PAT CPU part number, serial number, sign and date this page and return to Product
Support Service Department.
S /N:_______________
S / N_______________
Signature:____________________
Date:_______________
Appendix 12
Fully retract boom and extend each section (in manual mode) from 18 to 24 and mark off
1 increments for 6 on the Inner, center and outer mid sections.
Select a load (including hook block) between 20,000 to 25,000 pounds and position it at a
25 to 30 radius.
TEST PROCEDURE:
Switch boom control system to automatic mode. (Note: Boom will be out of sequence.)
Hoist load approximately 2 off of the ground with the boom nose positioned over the load.
Keep the engine running or the ignition switch on during the test.
Observe the marks on the boom sections for 30 minutes to determine which section(s) are
retracting. A slight compression of the oil is normal when the load is picked.
Approximately 1 per section would be expected. The sections should extend back to the
original position when the load is lowered to the ground.
Hoist the load to the ground, observe and record the movement of the marks on the boom
sections.
Determine which section(s) are retracting and reposition the boom sections to there original
positions.
Switch boom control system to manual mode and select a section that is not retracting. This
Will help to determine if the hold valve is leaking or if the cylinder has an internal leak.
Appendix 13
Repeat steps 2 through 5. If the section(s) do not retract in the manual mode, the hold
valve is most likely leaking. If the section retracts, the cylinder may have an internal leak
or both the hold valve and the two way valve on the piston side are leaking.
NOTE: The piston side two way valves located inside the boom are N.O. valves connected in-line
with the hold valves. When in the Automatic Mode with the telescope controller in the neutral
position and the power on, the piston side two way valves are not powered shut. This permits any
leakage past the hold valve to drain through the piston side drain valve and the .078 in line orifice.
When in the Manual Mode under the same conditions, the two way valves are powered shut on the
sections not selected. This should block any leakage from the hold valve and prevent the cylinder
from retracting. Prior to assuming that the cylinder has a leak, the two way valve should be checked
to ensure that 24 volts are present at the valve with the system in manual mode with an other
section selected.
Thermal contraction will cause a cylinder to retract as the fluid in the cylinder cools. The change in
length of the cylinder is proportional to the extended length of the cylinder and the change of the
temperature of the oil in the cylinder. The coefficient of expansion for API Group 1 oil is
approximately 0.00043/ 0F. A cylinder that is extended 25 which has had the oil cool 100 F would
retract about 13 as the oil cools. A cylinder that is extended 2 which has had the oil cool 100
Degrees F will retract about 1 due to the thermal contraction. Testing the boom almost fully
refracted greatly reduces the effect of thermal contraction and ensures a proper diagnosis of the
system.
Appendix 14
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 12
A2B SIGNAL
PROXY (+)
GND
7 8 10 11 9 35 34 24 73 43 36 80 78 76
A2B GND
LENGTH (IM)
LENGTH (CM)
IS
AGND
LENGTH (O.A. BOOM)
30 31 32 33 44 46
-5V
ANGLE
+24V
TXD
RXD
GND
LMI BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
AGND
-5V
+5V
IS
AGND
-5V
+5V
IS
A 104
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 28 29
X1
1 4 3
1 2 3 4 IS 1 2 3 4
2 56 7 8 9
13
11
+24V
IS
GN/YL
To page 12.2
IS 1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14
14
12
12.1
A
14 SOCKET PLUG
A BCD
A BCD
PRES. TRANS.
(ROD)
1 2 3 4
A BCD
A BCD
PRES. TRANS.
(PISTON)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
A BC DE FG H I
L M N
A BC DE FG H I
L M N
1 2 3 4
To Boom Base
Junction Box
5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
14 PIN PLUG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
X1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+24V
GND
TXD
RXD
COM.
A2B
LMI
DI
1 2 3 4
X7 1 2 3 4
+24V
GND
X8
1
2
CONSOLE
TMS/TTS 870
WIRING CONNECTIONS
IS
A111
1
X1
2 3
13 14 15 20 21
23 - SOCKET RECEPT
S/S HARNESS (REF)
TMS/TTS 870
INTERFACE
TELE EXT PROP SOL
10 11 12
56 57 1 2 3 4 48 38 40 42 36 37 39 41 75 77 79 59 61 49 62 63 64
8 719
240
147
238
1083
255
257
6 9
To Boom Base
Junction Box
4
323
B
3
CM TELE
2 3 5 7 11 12 13 14 1
IM TELE
8 10
OM/FLY TELE
HIGH=AUTO / NONE=MANUAL
12.2
1
7 8
4 5 6
68 69
GND
A113
X1
71
51
73
387
388
239
242
243
244
K6 (COM) +24V
K6 (NO) +24V TO CM 2-WAY SOLS
65 66
+24V
K2 (COM) +24V
K2 (NO) +24V TO IM 2-WAY SOLS
53 54
4 5 6
18
16
5
6 9 10
DI E5 GND
DI E5 (+24V=CM RET)
A114
3 4
X1
DI E3 (+24V)
[ +24=MODE A
0V=MODE B
DI E2 GND
DI E2
A1 (PROP)
AGND
GND
GND
+24V
+24V
K5 (COM)
K5 (NO) OUTPUT TO EXT PROP
K4 (COM) +24V
K4 (NC) +24V TO TELE OUT OF SEQ
DI 6 GND
DI 4 GND
DI 5 GND
DI 2 GND
DI 3 GND
DI 1 GND
DI GND
K3 (COM) +24V
K7 (COM) +24V
+24V
IS
DI EXTENSION BOARD
24 350 300 301
9 10 11 12
7
12
9
8
17 22 23 24 25
14 SOCKET PLUG
1 14
8 9
10
IS
11 12 13
3 4
5 6
10
11 12 13 14
IS
H J
L M N
D E F G H
L M N P R S T U V
H J
L M N
D E F G H
L M N P R S T U V
8 9
10
11 12 13 14
3 4 5 6 7 8
10
11 12
14
7 8
2
13
1 7
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4
12
5 9 6 7
4
13
10 11
7 5 8
29
30
14
9 10 11 12
31
12
14
TMS/TTS870
WIRING
CONNECTIONS
5 6
12.3
123 6 7
10 11
12 4 9 10
3
2
1
AGND
SIG.
-5V
10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
GRA
0 0
VIO
RED
PNK
YEL
BLU
WHT
BRN
GRN
CRE
BLK
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
4.7K
SHD
VV
4.7K
WHT/
BLK
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BLK
VV
A B
A B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
1234
12
LENGTH
TRANS.
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BLK
BRN
RED
3=RED
2=BRN
1=BLK
BLK
WHT/BLK
SHEILD
CORE
10 11
SHD
AGND
SIG.
-5V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
ANGLE
TRANS.
LENGTH/ANGLELWG221 (TOCM)
LENGTH
TRANS.
LENGTH
TRANSDUCER
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
VIO
AGND
SIG.
-5V
SIG.
AGND
-5V
56
1
3
4
2
11
2 4
1234
5 8
RED
PNK
YEL
BLU
9 14 12 7 5
CRE
BLK
8 6 4
WHT
BRN
GRN
1 2 3 13
BLK
WHT/BLK
WHT/
BLK
GRA
1
1
5 6
VIO
YEL
PNK
RED
BLK
GRA
BLU
CRE
SHD
WHT
BRN
GRN
JUNCTION
BOX (CM)
RED
1
1
RED
2
3 BLK 1
BLK
4
5 GRN 1
TIE WRAP
USED TO IDENTIFY CABLE
GRN
6
WHT
1
7
WHT
8
9
3
10
4
11
1
PROXY SW 3 (TOP)
(LENGTH RESET)
1
1 (+)
4
4 NO
2
2 NC
3
3 (-)
PROXY SW 1
(OM/FLY RETR)
1
4
2
IS
(+)
4 NO
2 NC
12.4
RED
YEL
BLU
VIO
GRA
BLK
CRE
PNK
1
2
3
4
(-)
SHD
WHT
BRN
GRN
5
6
7
RED
BLK
GRN
WHT
3
4
1
1
4
2
IS
IS
(+)
4 NO
2 NC
(-)
IS
IS
JUNCTION
BOX (IM)
4
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
3
4
4
1
1
2
JUNCTION BOX
BOOM BASE
PROXY SW 2 (BOTTOM)
(CM/IM RETR. 2-POSITIONS)
1
1 (+)
4
O O
4 NO
2
2 NC
O O
3
3 (-)
IS
TMS/TTS 870
WIRING CONNECTIONS
30 31 32 33 44 46
PROXY (+)
GND
A2B SIGNAL
A2B GND
LENGTH (IM)
LENGTH (CM)
-5V
ANGLE
IS
AGND
LENGTH (O.A. BOOM)
+24V
TXD
RXD
GND
LMI BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
AGND
-5V
+5V
IS
AGND
-5V
+5V
IS
A 104
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 28 29
X1
7 8 10 11 9 35 34 24 73 43 36 80 78 76
1 2 3 4
IS 1 2 3 4
1 4 3
2 56 7 8 9
13
11
+24V
IS
GN/YL
To page 12.6
IS 1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
14
12
12.5
A
14 SOCKET PLUG
A BCD
A BCD
PRES. TRANS.
(ROD)
1 2 3 4
A BCD
A BCD
PRES. TRANS.
(PISTON)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
A BC DE FG H I
L M N
A BC DE FG H I
L M N
To Boom Base
Junction Box
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
RT865BXL
WIRING CONNECTIONS
14 PIN PLUG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
X1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+24V
GND
TXD
RXD
COM.
A2B
LMI
DI
1 2 3 4
X7 1 2 3 4
+24V
GND
X8
1
2
CONSOLE
2 3
13 14 16 20 21 17 22 23 24 25
A B C D E F G H J KLM N O P Q R S T UV W X
A B C D E F G H J KLM N O P Q R S T UV W X
4 5 6
18
7
8 9 10
12o
1 2 3 4
A B C D E
A B C D E
NO
COM
348o NC
DI E5 GND
DI E5 (+24V=CM RET)
DI E1 GND
A1 (PROP)
AGND
GND
GND
+24V
+24V
K5 (COM)
K5 (NO) OUTPUT TO EXT PROP
K4 (COM) +24V
K4 (NC) +24V TO TELE OUT OF SEQ
DI 6 GND
DI 4 GND
DI 5 GND
DI 2 GND
DI 3 GND
DI 1 GND
DI GND
K3 (COM) +24V
A114
1 2
X1
AREA DEF.
INTERFACE
5 SOCKET PLUG
A111
1
X1
SWIVEL HARNESS
5 PIN RECEPTACLE
IS
238
1083
255
257
56 57 1 2 3 4 48 38 40 42 36 37 39 41 75 77 79 59 61 49 62 63 64
23 - SOCKET RECEPT
S/S HARNESS (REF)
RT865BXL
INTERFACE
8 7 19 10 11 12
6 9
323
74
744
To Boom Base
Junction Box
4
B
3
CM TELE
8 10 2 3 5 7 11 12 13 14 1
IM TELE
OM/FLY TELE
7 8
12.6
1
5 6
K7 (COM) +24V
68 69
A113
4
X1
71
51
73
387
388
239
242
243
244
K6 (COM) +24V
K6 (NO) +24V TO CM 2-WAY SOLS
65 66
GND
K2 (COM) +24V
K2 (NO) +24V TO IM 2-WAY SOLS
53 54
+24V
+24V
47
IS
DI EXTENSION BOARD
24 350 300 301
9 10 11 12
7
12
9
8
15
1 2 3 4
14 SOCKET PLUG
1 14
8 9
10
11 12 13
IS
5 6
10
11 12 13 14
IS
H J
L M N
D E F G H
L M N P R S T U V
H J
L M N
D E F G H
L M N P R S T U V
5 6
8 9
10
10
11 12
3 4 5 6 7 8
14
3
4
7 8
2
13
1 7
2 3
19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18
4
12
5 9 6 7
4
13 8
6
10 11
7 5
29
30
14
9 10 11 12
31
12
14
RT865BXL
WIRING
CONNECTIONS
5 6
12.7
123 6 7
10 11
12
3
2
1
AGND
SIG.
-5V
10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
GRA
0 0
VIO
RED
PNK
YEL
BLU
WHT
BRN
GRN
CRE
BLK
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
4.7K
SHD
VV
4.7K
WHT/
BLK
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BLK
VV
A B
A B
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
1234
12
LENGTH
TRANS.
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BLK
BRN
RED
3=RED
2=BRN
1=BLK
BLK
WHT/BLK
SHEILD
CORE
10 11
SHD
AGND
SIG.
-5V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
LENGTH
TRANSDUCER
ANGLE
TRANS.
LENGTH/ANGLELWG221 (TOCM)
LENGTH
TRANS.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
1
3
4
2
11
VIO
AGND
SIG.
-5V
SIG.
AGND
-5V
56
5 8
2 4
123 4
4 9 10
RED
PNK
YEL
BLU
9 14 12 7 5
CRE
BLK
8 6 4
WHT
BRN
GRN
1 2 3 13
BLK
WHT/BLK
WHT/
BLK
GRA
1
1
11 12 13 14
VIO
YEL
PNK
RED
BLK
GRA
BLU
CRE
SHD
WHT
BRN
GRN
JUNCTION
BOX (CM)
RED
1
1
RED
2
3 BLK 1
BLK
4
5 GRN 1
TIE WRAP
USED TO IDENTIFY CABLE
GRN
6
WHT
1
7
WHT
8
9
3
10
4
11
1
PROXY SW 3 (TOP)
(LENGTH RESET)
1
1 (+)
4
4 NO
2
2 NC
3
3 (-)
PROXY SW 1
(OM/FLY RETR)
1
4
2
IS
(+)
4 NO
2 NC
12.8
RED
YEL
BLU
VIO
GRA
BLK
CRE
PNK
1
2
3
4
(-)
SHD
WHT
BRN
GRN
5
6
7
RED
BLK
GRN
WHT
3
4
1
1
4
2
IS
IS
(+)
4 NO
2 NC
(-)
IS
IS
JUNCTION
BOX (IM)
4
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
2
3
4
4
1
1
2
JUNCTION BOX
BOOM BASE
PROXY SW 2 (BOTTOM)
(CM/IM RETR. 2-POSITIONS)
1
1 (+)
4
O O
4 NO
2
2 NC
O O
3
3 (-)
IS
RT865BXL
WIRING CONNECTIONS
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 13
X1
L1
J2
1
J1
L1
J1
J2
1
X1
13.1
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 14
14.1
VIEW OF BACKSIDE
OF GRAPHIC CONSOLE
J1
J2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
X1
MP 1
+UB
MP 0
GND
MP 7
MP 6
MP 2
+7V
MP 5
+5V
J4
J5
X5 1 2 3 4
J3
MP 4
-24V
MP 3
-24V
+UB
GND
RXD
TXD
A2B BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
LMI BYPASS
+UB
+UB
GND
CENTRAL UNIT
MAIN BOARD
51 52 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
8
2 3
5 6 7
6 7
10
10
11 12 13 14
CONSOLE (1318)
A B C D
1 2 3 4
LOAD
DI
A2B
8 X1
GND
A2B
X7 1 2 3 4
LIGHTBAR
4 5 6
RXD
4 5
TXD
SIG -
+UB
GND
+UB
SIG +
14.2
X8
+UB 1
GND 2
9 11 12 13 14
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 15
DESCRIPTION
X1 TERM.
DESCRIPTION
1,3
27
Length Signal
2,4
GND ( ) Battery-Input
28
GND
29
Angle Signal
30
Force Signal
31
A2B Signal
32
A2B Ground
A2B Bypass
A2B Bypass
33,34,35,36
9
LMI Bypass
10
+ 12V (ub)
11
+UBR
12
13
Ext. Hor. # 1
14
Not Used
51
+UB
52
GND
53
Fuse (4 AMP)
54
Fuse (4 AMP)
57
Not Used
58
Not Used
60
+UBS
+UBS
15
GND
16
Digital Input # 1
61
Fuse (10AMP)
17
Digital Input # 2
62
18
Digital Input # 3
64
UB
65
GND
19
Digital Input # 4
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
66,67,68,69
15.1
Not Used
76
+UB
77
GND
+UBS
+
CONSOLE 4
K8
DIN
DIN
F2- 10A
REL
DAV 1
DAV 2
LWG 1
LG 2
HES
DHG
S1
SI-UB
24 352 31 0001
ADDITIONAL TERMS
LOAD
KEY
SWITCH
SI-REL
DE 5,6
+UBS
76
77
+ +UBS
0V
15.2
A107
MEMORY
EXTENTION
12V
S2
DE 1-4
K10B
X3
+UBS
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
17
DE 2
18
DE 3
19
DE 4
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
26
+ +UBS
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG
1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
58
A2B-I
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
64
+ +UBS
65
0V
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
X12
+ +UBS
A105 SERIAL
EXTENSION
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
K9
A102
X11
CPUMODULE
0V
RXD
TXD
10
K10A
+ +UBS
STOP
LOAD
SWITCH
5
6
7
8
9
+ +12V
0V
X3
2
3
A103
DATENMODULE
12V
A104 DIGITAL
OUTPUT
+UB
F1
1 3
2 3
4 1
2 3
V V V
6 PIN PLUG
+UBE
SIG+
SIGGND
+UB
GND
TXD
RXD
A2B
A2B
LOAD
D1
GN/YL
73
(LMI UNLOCK SOL.)
A
A
B C
B C
V V
V V
71 (+UB)
51 (GND)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V V
LIGHTBAR
V V V
1 2 3 4
A B C
A B C
A BC D
V V V V
1 2 3 4
V V
NO
C
1 2 3 4
V V V V
1 2 3 4
V V VV V V
X7 1 2 3 4
X8
+UBE 1
GND 2
A BCD E
A BCD E
V V V V V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X1
1 2 3 4 5 6
TO MAIN BOOM
CONNECTOR
NC
over front
on rubber
DS350
GRAPHIC MODULAR
CENTRAL UNIT
10 AMP
FUSE
NOTES:
NO
NC
on outriggers
+UBS
LMI BYPASS
FUSE (4 amp)
FUSE (4 amp)
4
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
5 PIN
DEUTSCH
1 2 3 4
PLUG
V V V V V
15.3
V
V
61 62
4 AMP
FUSE
10 8 9 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
59 60
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 53 54
CONSOLE (1318)
1 2 3
NOT USED
NOT USED
NOT USED
NOT USED
A2B GROUND
A2B SIGNAL
ANGLE
FORCE
GND
LENGTH
+UB
GND
ROD
+UB
GND
PISTON
+UB
DI4
DI3
DI1
DI2
GND
EXT. HOR. *1
23 24 25
IN
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 10 11 12 13 14
20 21 22
OUT
13 14 15 16 17 18 19
OUT
+UBS
GND
+UB
GND
RXD
TXD
A2B BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
LMI BYPASS
+UB
51 52 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
IN
GN/YL
1 2 3
+UB
+UBR
LMI UNLOCK S.
+UB
GND
X1 1 2 12 11
pres. trans.
(piston)
pres. trans.
(rod)
G1
MP42
KGND
MP 26
KGND
MP 4
+5V
MP 9
+6V
X15
GND
GND
AGND
KGND
+BATT
MP24
MP23
VBAT
+UB1
PWM DC
MP 8
+9V
GND
5
+UB1 +UB
DI 6
KGND
X12
MP41 MP40
V10 H11 V11
H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6
DI 1
MP21
PFAIL+UB1
DI 1- DI 6 =>
X17
power o.k.
X14
J11
X11
SP5
X13
H12
TXD
AGND
H10
K8
MP29
10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K10
A2B
+UB
2
1
MAIN
ON/OFF
KGND
J10
3
4
LMI
KGND
10
LOAD
+5V/RS232
AGND
F1
69 68 67 66 65 64
62 61
60 59 58 57
55 54
52 51
12
KGND
3
1
77 76
F2
H9
A2B
KGND
J4
J3
J2
J1
KGND
X1
12
11
KGND
K9
11
X1
13
X16
KGND
MP
1 +UB
36
35 34 33
32
31
30 29 28 27 26
25 24 23
22 21 20
19 18 17 16 15
14
13 12 11
10 9
MP25
LOCATIONS :
LEDS
H 8 - zone M3 - LOAD
H 9 - zone E11 - A2B
H 10 - zone G9 - MAIN IN/OUT
H 11 - zone M3 - POWER
H 12 - zone I11 - TXD
15.4
13
MP7
J1
J13
J12
J2
D3
D1
MP4
D2
X1
D14
X2
D13
P1
SYSTEM
D10
J8
D6
J9 MP3 J6
D17
J10
D15
D7
D21
D9
D12
J15
J11
J14
D18
J7
D11
D19
D20
X3
BR6
MP6MP5
EJECT
BR5
MP2
A102 CPU
J1
J2
DATA
D1
J5
J3
TLK
D3
J6
BR
4
3
2
1
X1
A103 DATEN
15.5
P7
MP12
1
2
40
AGND
AGND
-
P6
MP13
J2
20
P5
16
P4
P3
MP9
J1
MP11
X16
P2
MP10
P1
1 1
2
X1
MP17
BR1
MP0
MP8
VREFA
P8
7
6
5
MP16 16
MP7 - MP1->
X17
1
2
MP14
3
2
1
40
1
2
AGND
AGND
ADC INPUT 0.5 V 4.5 V, Note: If channel adjustments are made through
the software and graphic console, DO NOT adjust offset with P1 - P7
= TEMP (0.5V + 10mV/oC)
MP 1 = AGND
= VREFA = 5.000V reference
MP 8 = + 5V
= AGND (reference GND)
MP 1 - 7 = Input channels 1 - 7 - 0.5V/ 4mA
= VREF+ = 5.0V power ADC
2.5V/20mA
= CH01-04, DIN 1-4 / 10
MP
14
=
+
13V
REF 02
= CH05, +UBS / 10
MP
16
=
HESIN
input voltage
= CH06, HESIN(A2B) *4
MP
17
=
app
5.4V
clamp for inputs
= CH07, +9V *4
= CH08, VREFA / 2 = 2.500V
= UKLEMM, app. VREFA, limits ADC input to 5.0V
15.6
MODEL:
S/N:
VDC
4.
5.
6.
VDC MP 1 Ground
VDC MP 1 Ground
VDC MP 1 Ground
VDC MP 1 Ground
VDC MP 1 Ground
VDC MP 1 Ground
VDC MP 1 Ground
Boom Length:
Fully Retracted
Ft.
Fully Extended
Ft.
Fully Retracted
Ft.
Fully Extended
Ft.
+12/+24V Volt Reference Voltage
mA @ X1-27
mA @ X1-27
VDC @ MP X1-3(A106), MP 0 (GND)
VDC @ MP X1-3(A106), MP 0 (GND)
VDC @ X1-26 (X1-28 GND)
Boom Angle:
Minimum Angle
Degs.
Maximum Angle
Degs.
Minimum Angle
Degs.
Maximum Angle
Degs.
+12/+24V Volt Reference Voltage
mA @ X1-29
mA @ X1-29
VDC @ MP X1-4(A106), MP 0 (GND)
VDC @ MP X1-4(A106), MP 0 (GND)
VDC @ X1-26 (X1-28 GND)
Pressure Transducers:
Piston Zero Point
mA @ X1-21 /
Rod Zero Point
mA @ X1-24 /
Piston +12/+24 Volt Reference Voltage
Rod +12/+24 Volt Reference Voltage
Analog Input Module (A106):
+5V @ MP8 =
+5V @ MP17=
+5V @ MP16=
VDC MP 0 Ground
VDC MP 0 Ground
VDC MP 0 Ground
15.7
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 16
P1
AGND
MP14
.0V
ERROR
CODE
J1
E11
.500v MIN.
MP7 - MP1->
1
2
MP16
16
1
2
AGND
BR1
20
40
X1
AGND
X1 26 27 28
WORKING
RANGE
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
VOLTAGES
X1 3 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL (RETRACTED BOOM)
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL (10 TURNS ON POT)
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 28) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
4.50v MAX.
ERROR
CODE
(GND)
P2
LENGTH
P3
MP9
VREFA
P4
+UB
MP12
P5
Channel # 1
OPERATING WINDOW
MP17
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E21
5.0V
16.1
2 3
E11 / E21
1
6 Pin
GND
7 8
X2
5 3 1
GND
5 3 1
5 3 1
X4
+UB
1 OUT
CORE
+UB
SHIELD
1 OUT
5 3 1
X3
Plug
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
6 Pin
6 5
7
4 3 2 1
Connector
16.2
NO. OF TURNS
ON CABLE
REEL
NO. OF TURNS
ON LENGTH
POT
SIGNAL AT X1 TERM.
PIN #27 ON C.P.U.
TERMINAL
SIGNAL ON ANALOG
MODULE AT X1-3
(X1-28 GND.)
4 mA
.5 V
5.5 mA
.9 V
7.2 mA
1.3 V
8.7 mA
1.7 V
12
10.4 mA
2.1 V
15
12.0 mA
2.5 V
18
13.6 mA
2.9 V
21
15.2 mA
3.3 V
24
16.8 mA
3.7 V
27
18.4 mA
4.1 V
30
10
20 mA
4.5 V
CHANNEL # 1
24.0
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16.3
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
A
X2
X1
9333103309
7 (9)
8 (10)
1.0
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16.4
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
A
X2
X1
9333103309
7 (9)
8 (10)
4.00
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
16.5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
A
X2
X1
9333103309
7 (9)
8 (10)
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 17
GRAPHIC CONSOLE
SPECIAL FUNCTION 0 - SETTING OF TRANSDUCER INPUT
0 - SETTING OF PRESSURE AND FORCE INPUTS
The 0 - setting consists of calculating an appropriate 0 - point offset, which, when added to the
transducer measurement, allows the real physical pressure of force to be calculated. To achieve
this, a procedure has been developed, allowing the 0 - setting to be performed and visualized in a
simple manner.
ACTIVATING THE 0 - SETTING FUNCTION
To activate the 0 - Setting Function, press the INFO key to activate the Info Function. Now press
the CTRL key. At this point, a five digit Authorization Number must be entered. Only authorized
personnel may adjust the 0 - point settings.
Example : 6 4 3 5 6
17.1
AGND
MP14
.0V
ERROR
CODE
J1
E12
.500v MIN.
MP7 - MP1->
1
2
MP16
16
1
2
17.2
VOLTAGES
X1 1 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL (ZERO PRESSURE)
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL (300 BAR PRESSURE)
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 22) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
AGND
BR1
20
40
X1
AGND
X1 20 21 22
-
WORKING
RANGE
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
4.50v MAX.
ERROR
CODE
(GND)
P1
(PISTON)
P2
OUTPUT SIGNAL
P3
MP9
VREFA
P4
+UB
MP12
P5
Channel # 2
OPERATING WINDOW
MP17
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E22
5.0V
2 3
E12 / E22
(measurements at transducer)
1 2 3
A B C
A B C
AGND
MP14
.0V
ERROR
CODE
J1
E13
.500v MIN.
MP7 - MP1->
1
2
MP16
16
1
2
17.3
VOLTAGES
X1 2 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL (ZERO PRESSURE)
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL (300 BAR PRESSURE)
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 25) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
E13 / E23
AGND
BR1
20
40
X1
AGND
X1 23 24 25
-
WORKING
RANGE
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
4.50v MAX.
ERROR
CODE
(GND)
P1
(ROD)
P2
OUTPUT SIGNAL
P3
MP9
+UB
P4
MP17
MP12
P5
Channel # 3
OPERATING WINDOW
VREFA
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E23
5.0V
2 3
(measurements at transducer)
1 2 3
A B C
A B C
+24.0
+0.
A
B
17.4
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 18
P5
P4
P3
P2
MP9
AGND
MP14
Channel # 5
OPERATING WINDOW
VREFA
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P1
P8
.500v MIN.
1
2
MP16
16
1
2
18.1
VOLTAGES
X1 4 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = 90o ANGLE MIN. SIGNAL
+ 2.50V = 45o ANGLE
+ 4.5 V = 0o ANGLE MAX. SIGNAL
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 28) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
E15 / E25
X1 26 28 29
WORKING
RANGE
AGND
BR1
20
40
X1
AGND
4.50v MAX.
ERROR
CODE
(90o TO 0o)
MP10
MP7 - MP1->
- +
MP11
E15
(GND)
J1
J2
+UB
MP17
ERROR
CODE
ANGLE
.0V
MP12
E25
5.0V
SHIELD
CORE
3 4
6 Pin
Plug
7 8
X2
5 3 1
X4
+UB
GND
5 3 1
1 OUT
+UB
GND
1 OUT
5 3 1
5 3 1
X3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
6 Pin
6 5
7
4 3 2 1
Connector
18.2
ACTUAL
BOOM ANGLE
IN DEGS.
90o
SIGNAL AT X1 TERM.
PIN #29 ON C.P.U.
TERMINAL
4.0 mA
SIGNAL ON ANALOG
MODULE AT X1-4
(X1-28 GND.)
0.48
85o
4.9 mA
+ .70
80o
5.7 mA
+ .92
75o
6.6 mA
+ 1.15
70o
7.4 mA
+ 1.37
65o
8.3 mA
+ 1.60
60o
9.2 mA
+ 1.80
55o
10.2 mA
+ 2.04
50o
11.2 mA
+ 2.26
45o
12.1 mA
+ 2.48
40o
12.9 mA
+ 2.70
35o
13.7 mA
+ 2.92
30o
14.7 mA
+ 3.15
25
15.6 mA
+ 3.38
20o
16.5 mA
+ 3.60
15o
17.3 mA
+ 3.82
10o
18.0 mA
+ 4.04
5o
19.2 mA
+ 4.27
0o
20 mA
+ 4.49
CHANNEL #5
24.0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
18.3
9333103309
X1
X2
X2
XB2
X2
XA2
7 (9)
8 (10)
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1.0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
18.4
9333103309
X1
X2
X2
XB2
X2
XA2
7 (9)
8 (10)
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
20.0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
18.5
9333103309
X1
X2
X2
XB2
X2
XA2
7 (9)
8 (10)
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
D S350
Graphic
Modular
Slewing Angle
18-6
1 2 3
4 1 2 3
1 2 3
6 2
+UBE
SIG+
SIGGND
1 2 3 4
X7 1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A B C
A B C
A B C
A B C
1 2 34 5 6
TO MAIN BOOM
CONNECTOR
pres. trans.
(piston)
pres. trans.
(rod)
GN/YL
+UBS
LMI BYPASS
FUSE (4 amp)
4
10 AMP
FUSE
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
6 PIN PLUG
+UB
GND
TXD
RXD
A2B
A2B
LOAD
D1
X8
+UBE 1
GND 2
V V V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X1
V V V
V V
V V
V
V
(LMI UNLOCK SOL.)
10 8 9 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
FUSE (4 amp)
4 AMP
FUSE
V V V
V
V
71 (+UB)
51 (GND)
73
GND
V V V
V V VV V V
V
V
18-7
V
V
CONSOLE (1318)
1 2 3
SLEW 2
+ 12 V
A2B GROUND
SLEW 1
A2B SIGNAL
ANGLE
GND
+UB
LENGTH
ROD
GND
+UB
GND
+UB
PISTON
DI4
DI2
DI3
DI1
+UBS
9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 10 11 12 13 14
IN
61 62
OUT
59 60
26 27 28 29 31 32 30 33 34 35 53 54
OUT
23 24 25
IN
1 2 3
51 52 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
GN/YL
1 2 12 11 13
DI GND
+UB
X2/1 1 2 3
GND
+UB
GND
RXD
TXD
A2B BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
LMI BYPASS
+UB
GND
K10 NC
EXT. HOR. *1
LMI UNLOCK S.
+UB
GND
X1
D.O.Module
V V V V
NOTES:
1
A BC D
V V V V
1 2 3 4
LIGHTBAR
DS350
GRAPHIC MODULAR
with SLEWING
POTINTIOMETER
P2
P1
1
2
MP7 - MP1->
MP16
16
MP14
VOLTAGES
X1 5 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL BOOM OVER FRONT
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL BOOM OVER REAR
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (MP 0) ON ANALOG BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
MP11
P3
MP9
J1
P4
DS350
GRAPHIC MODULAR
SLEW ANGLE
#1
J2
P5
- +
MP0
MP8
BR1
P8
VREFA
AGND
AGND
20
40
P6
MP13
MP10
P7
MP17
X1
MP12
- +
4 mA
.500V (A106)
18-8
AGND
1
2
E2A
WORKING
RANGE
E1A
5.0V
4.50v MAX.
.500v MIN.
AGND
12 mA
2.5V (A106)
12 mA
2.5V (A106)
OPEN
4.5V (A106)
ERROR
CODE
ERROR
CODE
OPERATING WINDOW
.0V
(GND)
SLEW ANGLE 1
+UB
2
2
W
1
R
5
Y
3
B
2 4 3
X1 33 30 35
SLEW ANGLE 2
P2
P1
1
2
MP7 - MP1->
MP16
16
MP14
VOLTAGES
X1 6 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL BOOM OVER FRONT
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL BOOM OVER REAR
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (MP 0) ON ANALOG BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
MP11
P3
MP9
J1
P4
DS350
GRAPHIC MODULAR
SLEW ANGLE
#2
J2
P5
- +
MP0
MP8
BR1
P8
VREFA
AGND
AGND
20
40
P6
MP13
MP10
P7
MP17
X1
MP12
- +
12 mA
2.5V (A106)
18-9
AGND
1
2
E2B
WORKING
RANGE
E1B
5.0V
4.50v MAX.
.500v MIN.
AGND
4 mA
.500V (A106)
OPEN
4.5V (A106)
12mA
2.5V (A106)
ERROR
CODE
ERROR
CODE
OPERATING WINDOW
.0V
(GND)
SLEW ANGLE 2
+UB
2
2
W
1
R
5
Y
3
B
3 4 2
X1 33 34 35
SLEW ANGLE 1
18-10
Potentiometer
18-11
Collar
Collar
18-12
18-13
18-14
18-15
18-16
1. Position the superstructure over the front and engage the house lock pin.
2. Set the Console to read Slewing Angle:
A. Complete the LMI console setup according to the cranes current
operating configuration.
B. Press limits LMI.
C. Press 4 for Slew Angle/virtual wall limits.
D. Press 1 for Slew Angle.
E. Press 2 or 3 to display Slewing Angle.
NOTE: Refer to the P.A.T. Load Moment Indicator Operators Handbook
for detailed instructions.
18-17
18-18
5. Disengage the house lock pin and swing approximately 10 deg. to the right
(clockwise). Slowly swing back to the left and engage the house lock pin*.
Rotate the body of the slew potentiometer until the slew angle indicates 0.6 deg.
(+/- 0.1 deg.). NOTE: This value may not be obtainable due to limited wire
length on the slew potentiometer, or the electrical terminals interferance with
one of the mounting screws, if this occurs,reposition the collar set screwed to
the potentiometer shaft and repeat step 5.
6. Disengage the house lock pin and swing approximately 10 deg. to the left
(counterclockwise). Slowly swing back to the right and engage the house lock
pin*. If the angle indicated on the console does not exceed +/- 1.0 deg.,
proceed to step 7. If the indicated angle exceeds +/- 1.0 deg. Return to step 5.
7. Tighten the three screws that secure the slew potentiometer to the mounting
plate. Install the slip ring cover.
8. Disengage the house lock pin and swing approximately 10 deg. to the right
(clockwise). Slowly swing back to the left and engage the house lock pin*. If
the angle indicated on the console does not exceed +/- 1.0 deg., proceed to step
9. If it does exceed +/- 1.0 return to step 4.
9. Disengage the house lock pin and swing approximately 10 deg. to the left
(counterclockwise). Slowly swing back to the right and engage the house lock
pin*. Verify the angle indicated on the console does not exceed +/- 1.0 deg. If
the angle exceeds +/- 1.0 deg., Return to step 4.
* IF THE SUPERSTRUCTURE SWINGS PAST THE HOUSE LOCK PIN
ENGAGED POSITION, THE PROCEDURE MUST BE REPEATED.
18-19
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 19
6 Pin
GND
19.1
2
1
7 8
X2
5 3 1
X4
1 2 3 4 5 6
5 3 1
X3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
6 Pin
6 5
1
1 2
4 3 2 1
NOTES:
OUTER SHIELD GROUNDED AT
1
STRAIN RELIEF CONNECTOR
2
IMPORTANT CHANGE
Plug
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5 3 1
+UB
5 3 1
GND
1 OUT
CORE
+UB
SHIELD
6 PIN
SHIELD
To Central Unit
1 OUT
1
2
3
4
5
6
CORE
CONNECTOR
4.7K
RESISTOR
Connector
To Central Unit
1
2
SHIELD
3 4
2
5 3 1
19.2
1
2
7 8 5 3 1
X2
X4
A
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
5 3 1
X3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
1 2
1 2
6 5
1 2
Plug
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5 3 1
+UB
1 2
3
6 Pin
GND
GND
CORE
CORE
1 OUT
SHIELD
+UB
A
B
1 OUT
6 Pin
4 3 21
Connector
NO.
1
1 2
PART NO.
QTY
1
2
3
4
5
9-333-102764
9-333-102717
9-333-102666
9-333-102663
9-333-102230
1
1
1
4
1
9-333-102765
DESCRIP.
COMP. ASSEM.
2-POLE JUMPER BAR
TAGS, TERMINAL STRIP
BLOCK, TERMINAL STRIP
SWITCH A2B, WITH RETAINER
CRIMP
COMP. ASSEM., DUMMY PLUG
NOTES:
OUTER SHIELD GROUNDED AT
1
STRAIN RELIEF CONNECTOR
2
IMPORTANT CHANGE
3 4
NO.
PART NO.
QTY
1
2
9-333-102238
9-333-102235
1
1
3+
4
9-333-102767
9-333-102687
1
2
19.3
DESCRIPTION
SWITCH, A2B W/O CRIMP
CONDUIT 10 FEET
(MUST CUT TO LENGTH)
JUNCTION BOX ASSEM.
SCREW
1(BLACK)
1
2(BROWN)
A2B CABLE
3(RED)
2
3
PART NO.
QTY
9-333-102758
9-333-102793
9-333-101984
9-333-102759
9-333-102663
9-333-102664
9-333-102665
9-333-102666
9-333-102760
9-333-102482
9-333-102612
9-333-102669
9-333-102266
9-333-102480
1
1
1
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
4
4
4
DESCRIPTION
Junction Box
Strain Relief (90o)
Locknut
Mounting rail, terminal strip
Block, terminal strip
End plate, terminal strip
End bracket, terminal strip
Tags, terminal strip
Connector, cannon 2-pin male recp.
Gasket
Cover, dust
Screw #4
Lockwasher #4
Nut #4
19.4
19.5
PART NO.
9-333-102238
7-110-151205
9-333-102235
9-333-102690
9-333-102687
NO.
1
2
3
4+
5
1
2
QTY
1
2
1
DESCRIPTION
Switch, A2B W/O Crimp
Capscrew
Conduit 10 feet
(must cut to length)
Junction box assembly
Screw
Fixed Swingaway
JUNCTION BOX ASSEMBLY
1(BLACK)
1
A2B CABLE
2(BROWN)
3(RED)
PART NO.
9-333-102758
9-333-102674
9-333-102759
9-333-102663
9-333-102664
9-333-102665
9-333-102666
9-333-102760
9-333-102482
9-333-102612
9-333-102669
9-333-102266
9-333-102480
QTY
DESCRIPTION
1
1
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
4
4
4
Junction Box
Strain Relief
Mounting rail, terminal strip
Block, terminal strip
End plate, terminal strip
End bracket, terminal strip
Tags, terminal strip
Connector, cannon 2-pin male recp.
Gasket
Cover, dust
Screw #4
Lockwasher #4
19.6
Nut #4
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 20
General Flowchart
Lever Lockout Activated
Broken Length Cable
No Display
Anti - Two - Block
Length Reading Problem
Angle Reading Problem
Load Reading Problem
Bad Data Transfer Between Console & Central Unit
Error Code Displayed
20.1
20.2
20.3
20.4
20.5
20.7
20.10
20.13
20.16
20.18
20.20
GENERAL FLOWCHART
This section explains how to handle a problem that may arise with the P.A.T. Load Moment
Indicator System - P.A.T. DS350 Graphic Modular. The procedures are easy to follow and are
given in flowcharts on the following pages. Start with general flowchart below which will
guide you to one of the more detailed flowcharts shown on pages 20.3 through 20.19.
START
Whats Wrong?
Lever Lockout
Activated
Length Cable
Problem
Go to Page 20.3
Go to Page 20.4
Wrong Length
Displayed
Go to Page 20.10
Wrong Angle
Displayed
Go to Page 20.13
No Display
No Function
Anti-Two-Block
Go to Page 20.5
Go to Page 20.7
Wrong Load
Displayed
Go to Page 20.16
20.2
Bad Data
Transfer
Error Code
Displayed
Go to Page 20.18
Go to Page 20.20
START
fixed?
YES
NO
Does the console indicate
Anti-Two-Block warning?
NO
YES
If console displays is
blank, fault is located
in power supply,
wiring or fuses.
Fault in Anti-Two
Block system.
Go to page 20.5
Go to page 20.7
20.3
STEP
ACTION
Open cable reel cover and disconnect wiring from terminal block. Pull 7- conductor
cable out of strain relief.
Remove damaged length cable, which is mounted to the slip rings in the cable reel,
from Terminal X1 and X2 See drawing 1 on page 20.28.
Turn the cable reel and open the stain relief attached to the axle in the center of the drum.
Pull existing length cable out of the cable reel.
Disconnect damaged length cable from Anti-Two-Block switch receptacle at the boom nose.
Pull new length cable through the hole, pipe and strain relief and push it through the axle of
the reeling drum. Tighten strain relief to ensure sealing.
Dismantle length cable near slip ring and reconnect shield to terminal No. X1 and center to
No. X2 See drawing 1 on page 20.28.
Remount cable reel to the boom. Turn reeling drum clockwise to get rest of new cable
onto the drum.
10
11
Reconnect new cable to Terminal No. 1 (center) and ground terminal (shield) of receptacle
at the boom nose.
12
20.4
NO DISPLAY
PROBLEM
Blank console display.
No warninglight shown.
Crane movements stopped.
START
correct?
NO
Replace fuses.
YES
Measure crane voltage on main board terminal
strip between X1-1(+12/24V) andX1-2 (ground).
This is an imput voltage from crane
Note: If crane voltage is measured below
10V system will switch off.
correct?
NO
YES
correct?
NO
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.5
NO DISPLAY
continued
PREVIOUS PAGE
correct?
NO
YES
END
20.6
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PROBLEM
Function of Anti-Two-Block System is faulty.
START
Check to see whether or not crane is in two-block condition.
NO
Lower hook down in safe position.
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
Measure the resistance at the boom nose
box between terminals 1 and 6 with
ohmmeter. This checks the function of the
Anti-Two-Block switch.
See drawing 2 on page 20.28.
Switch Closed = 4700 +/- 500 Ohms
Switch Open = > 1 Megaohm
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.7
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
YES
Measure the A2B signal in the boom base
box between terminal 5 and 6 with an ohmeter.
Anti-Two-Block switch open = > 1 megohm
Anti-Two-Block switch closed = 4700 Ohms
+ 500 Ohms.
Reconnect length cable to slip ring.
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.8
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
Disconnect X1-31 and X1-32.
Check main board function by installing a
temporary resistor, 4700 Ohms, between X131 and X1-32 in central unit. With resistor
connected alarm should be inactive.
NO
correct?
END
20.9
START
correct?
NO
YES
Check power supply to length
transducer on main board,
terminal X1-28 (ground) and
X1-26 (+12/24V).
See drawing 3 on page 20.29.
correct?
NO
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.10
NO
correct?
YES
Measure signal from length transducer
in cable reel at X1-2 and wire #2, the
return signal is a current output. Measurement should be in series.
Retracted Boom =
0 Potentiometer Turns = 4mA
10 Potentiometer Turns = 20mA
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.11
PREVIOUS PAGE
correct?
YES
NO
END
20.12
START
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.13
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.14
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
END
20.15
NO
correct?
YES
Check boom length reading on display.
Reset length potentiometer. With fully retracted
boom, turn potentiometer axle counterclockwise
until it stops .
See drawing 7 on page 20.33.
NO
correct?
YES
Measure radius and check with the
displayed radius.
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
correct?
NO
NEXT PAGE
20.16
NO
4-20mA
correct?
YES
YES
Measure pressure transducer signals on the analog input module between test
points, (Piston side, MP0 (GND) and X1-1) (Rod side, MP0 (GND) and X1-2).
The measurement should be between 0.5V - 4.5V at 0 PSI to 4.5V at 4410PSI.
Refer to Drawing 5 on page 20.31.
NO
correct?
YES
END
20.17
NO
correct?
YES
Measure process voltage on the main board in the
central unit between MP24 (+5V) and MP0 (GND).
Refer to Drawing 3 on page 20.29.
NO
correct?
Off
YES
NEXT PAGE
20.18
PREVIOUS PAGE
NO
correct?
YES
Ensure that cable shields are connected correctly.
Refer to connections and wiring diagrams.
NO
correct?
YES
Find out which component of the crane electric
is spiking out (e.g. dump valve, outrigger relay).
Install a diode or varistor across terminals of
spiking component. Diode type such as 1N 4001
can be used (watch + and - connection for diode).
END
20.19
INTERFERENCE PROBLEM
PROBLEM
Interference from crane electric.
Error Code E93 / E94 intermittent.
Frozen console displays.
START
Check system out; refer to Section 8 - Bad Data
Transfer Between Console & Central Unit.
NO
Replace or repair part which is defective.
correct?
YES
Check if additional ground like between main
board terminal X9 and central unit box mounting
bracket is in place. Refer to Drawing 4, Main
Board, in Section 11.
NO
correct?
YES
Ensure that cable shields are connected correctly.
Refer to connections and wiring diagrams, Drawings 9A,B,C in Section 11.
NO
correct?
YES
Find out which component of the crane electric
is spiking out (e.g. dump valve, outrigger relay).
Install a diode or varistor across terminals of
spiking component. Diode type such as 1N 4001
can be used (watch + and - connection for diode).
Refer to Drawing 7, Suppressor Diode, in Section 11.
END
20.20
PROBLEM
Error code displayed. Lever lockout activated.
Warning lights on.
ERROR
DISPLAY
ERROR
CAUSE
ACTION
E 01*
E 02*
E 03*
E 04*
E 05*
E 06*
20.21
ERROR
CAUSE
E 07
No acknowledgement signal
from overload relay (K8).
E 08
No acknowledgement signal
from Anti-Two-Block switch
relay (K9).
E 11
E 12
E 13
E 14
ACTION
Pressure transducer on
piston side defective.
Electronic component in
the measuring channel defective
on main board.
20.22
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 15
E 16
ERROR
Fallen below lower limiting
value for the measuring
channel "angle main boom".
E 17
CAUSE
ACTION
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
See page 20.37.
E 18
E 19
Electronic component on
the main board defective.
+5 volt supply
E 1A
E 1B
E 21
20.23
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 22
E 23
E 24
E 25
E 26
ERROR
Upper limiting value for the
measuring channel "pressure
piston side exceeded.
CAUSE
ACTION
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
20.24
ERROR
Upper limit value for the measurchannel 7 exceeded.
CAUSE
Cable from central unit to the
Sensor of channel 7 defective
or loose.
Sensor of channel 7 defective.
Electronic component in the
measuring channel 7 defective.
E 29
E 2A
E 2B
E 31
E 37
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
Replace angle sensor and reset
mechanical adjustment.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
E 38
E 39
E 41
Internal defect in
digital part of CPU.
E 42
ACTION
20.25
ERROR
CAUSE
E 42
E 43
E 45
Error in internal
communications.
Error in A/D
conversion
Malfunction in the
monitored write/read
memory.
E 46
E 47
Defective electronic
component.
Defective electronic
component.
Internal defect in
in digital part of CPU
ACTION
Exchange write/read memory
(CMOS-RAM). Replace main
Board and reset pressure
channels.
Exchange write/read memory
(CMOS-RAM). Replace main
Board and reset pressure
channels.
Replace main board and
reset pressure channels.
Replace main board and
reset pressure channels.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
E 48
E 51
E 52
E 56
E 58
E 61
E 63
E 69
Same action as E 57
Replace main board.
Check connections
Replace module.
Replace buss extension
20.26
ERROR
CAUSE
E 71
Incorrect acknowledgment
of the 1 relay on the main board.
console to central unit.
E 72 E 77
E 80
E 84
ACTION
Replace main board.
E 85
E 89
E 91
E 92
E 93
20.27
ERROR
DISPLAY
ERROR
E 94
E 95
CAUSE
ACTION
E 96
E 97
E 98
EAB
Note:
If an error message is displayed which is not contained in above list, please con Grove or PAT service departments.
20.28
G1
KGND
KGND
MP 4
+5V
MP 9
+6V
X15
GND
MP 26
GND
AGND
KGND
MP24
MP23
VBAT
+BATT
+UB1
PWM DC
MP42
MP 8
+9V
GND
5
+UB1 +UB
DI 6
KGND
X12
MP41 MP40
V10 H11 V11
H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6
DI 1
MP21
PFAIL+UB1
DI 1- DI 6 =>
X17
power o.k.
X14
J11
X11
SP5
X13
TXD
H12
AGND
H10
K8
MP29
10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K10
A2B
+UB
2
1
MAIN
ON/OFF
KGND
J10
3
4
LMI
KGND
10
LOAD
+5V/RS232
AGND
K9
69 68 67
66 65 64
63 62
61 60 59 58
57 56
55 54
12
KGND
3
1
77 76
F
1
H9
A2B
KGND
KGND
J4
J3
J2
J1
X1
12
11
KGND
F
2
11
X1
13
X16
KGND
MP1
+UBS
36 35 34 33
32 31
30 29 28 27 26
25
24 23
22 21 20
19 18 17
16 15 14
13 12
LOCATIONS :
MP 1 - zone M13 = GND.
MP 25 - zone M13 = +UBS
MP 8 - zone M2 = +9V
MP 9 - zone M2 = +6V
MP 4 - zone M1 = +5V
MP 26 - zone M1 = GND.
MP 23 - zone A2 = VBATT
MP 24 - zone D2 = +BATT
MP 40 - zone M4 = +UB
11
10 9
13
MP 25
LEDS
MP 41 - zone M4 = POWER FAIL
MP 42 - zone G1 = +5V
MP 21 - zone E5 = +5V
MP 29 - zone D10 = +5V
H1-H6 - zone I5 = DI 1-6
20.29
H 8 - zone M3 - LOAD
H 9 - zone E11 - A2B
H 10 - zone G9 - MAIN IN/OUT
H 11 - zone M3 - POWER
H 12 - zone I11 - TXD
MP7
J1
J13
J12
J2
D3
D1
MP4
D2
X1
D14
X2
D13
P1
SYSTEM
D10
J8
D6
J9 MP3 J6
D17
J10
D15
D7
D21
D9
D12
J15
J11
J14
D18
J7
D11
D19
D20
X3
BR6
MP6MP5
EJECT
BR5
MP2
A102 CPU
J1
J2
DATA
D1
J5
J3
TLK
D3
J6
BR
4
3
2
1
X1
A103 DATEN
20.30
P7
MP12
1
2
40
AGND
AGND
-
P6
MP13
J2
20
P5
16
P4
P3
MP9
J1
MP11
X16
P2
MP10
P1
1 1
2
X1
MP17
BR1
MP0
MP8
VREFA
P8
MP7 - MP1->
X17
1
2
MP16
16
6 5
4 3
MP14
2 1
40
1
2
AGND
AGND
20.31
20.32
J1
J2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
X1
MP 1
+UB
MP 0
GND
MP 7
MP 6
MP 2
+7V
MP 5
+5V
J4
J5
X5 1 2 3 4
J3
MP 4
-24V
MP 3
-24V
20.33
9333103309
X1
X2
X2
XB2
X2
1
3
5
7 (9)
8 (10)
1
2
3
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
+UB
GND
RXD
TXD
A2B BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
LMI BYPASS
+UB
+UB
GND
CENTRAL UNIT
MAIN BOARD
51 52 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
8
1 2 3
5 6
11 12 13 14
9 11 12 13 14
4 5 6
8 X1
A B C D
1 2 3 4
DI
A2B
10
GND
X7 1 2 3 4
LIGHTBAR
LOAD
A2B
4 5
TXD
SIG -
+UB
GND
RXD
CONSOLE (1318)
+UB
SIG +
20.34
7 10
X8
+UB 1
GND 2
1 2 3
GN/YL
1 2 12 11
51 (GND)
1 2 3
X1
+UB
GND
CENTRAL UNIT
MAIN BOARD
+UBR
71 (+UB)
LMI UNLOCK S.
73
20.35
(LMI UNLOCK SOL.) GN/YL
PISTON
+UB
B
B
C
C
PRESS. TRANS.
(PISTON)
A
A
1 2 3 4
20 21 22
GND
1 2 3
GN/YL
1 2 12 11
51 (GND)
1 2 3
X1
+UB
GND
CENTRAL UNIT
MAIN BOARD
+UBR
71 (+UB)
LMI UNLOCK S.
73
20.36
(LMI UNLOCK SOL.) GN/YL
ROD
+UB
B
B
C
C
PRESS. TRANS.
(ROD)
A
A
1 2 3 4
23 24 25
GND
4.7K
RESISTOR
>1>
>2>
>3>
>4>
>5>
>6>
2
+UB
LEN
(GND) 0.0V
3
CORE
SHIELD
6 PIN RECEPTACLE
1 2
ANGLE
FORCE
7
A2B SIG.
A2B GROUND
5 6
FUSE (4 AMP)
FUSE (4 AMP)
NOT USED
NOT USED
NOT USED
NOT USED
CORE
X2
SHIELD
X1
5 3 1
5 3 1
X3
X4
X2
3 2
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
5 3 1
5 3 1
7 8
RED
BRN
CABLE REEL
ANGLE SIG.
3 4
GND
1 2
+UB
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 53 54
GND
CENTRAL UNIT
MAIN BOARD
+UB
LENGTH SIG.
20.37
6 PIN RECEPTACLE
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6 SOCKET PLUG
20-38
20-39
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 21
10
CONSOLE
BY - PASS
KEY
3
4
8
5
4
3
21.1
AB
A2B
3
4
DATA TO C.U.
2
1
3
(GND) 2
(+24 V)
GRAPHIC CONSOLE
4A
13
14
10A
= CONNECTED
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
K10A
+ +UBS
0V
RXD
TXD
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
+ +UBS
K9
K8
F2- 10A
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
DE 2
17
DE 3
18
DE 4
19
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
+ +UBS
26
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG 1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
A2B-I
58
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
+ +UBS
64
0V
65
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
+UBS
+
76
0V
77
K10B
X4
BRN
1
2 WHT
PNK
3 GRA
4
5 GRN
6 YEL
WHT
WHT
BRN
BRN
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
YEL
GRN
3-Pair
Twisted
Cable
GRA
PNK
X2
1
2
GRN
3
YEL
4
5
6
PNK
7
GRA
8
BRN
WHT
BUS EXTENSION
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
+ +24V
0V
MAIN BOARD
LMI
+UBS
W # 71K = 24 VOLTS
F1
STOP
W # 51AJ = GND
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
+UB
X1
1
2
PAT
DS 350
STOP
STOP
156ft
0335
TARE
90.0ft
?
Ramp Seq.
IM Hex Value
255
CM Hex Value
STOP
79.4o
LIM
SEL
255
50.8ft
MAX
02 73.5oo
38.2
38.2
38.2
38.2
100%
(lbs)
ACT
(lbs)
34.900
100%
i
CTRL
100%
STOP
F1
Length of IM
F2
F3
F4
Tot. Length
minus IM
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 22
DI 1
DI 2
DI 3
DIGITAL DI 4
INPUT DI 5
DI 6
DI 7
DIGITAL INPUTS
BOOM EXTEND
BOOM RETRACT
OM / FLY RET.
IM RET.
IM % RESET
K5 NC
22.1
K6
K7
K5
RxD
TxD
AO1
IM 2 WAY SOL.
CM 2 WAY SOL.
OM 2 WAY SOL.
ON CM SECTION
ON IM SECTION
ON BASE SECTION
ON BASE SECTION
CABLE
REEL
DIGITAL
OUTPUT K2
CRANE
INTERFACE
CONNECTOR
PROP. EXT.
PROP. RET.
BOOM
CONTROL BUS
EXTENSION
PROX. SW.
PROX. SW.
PROX. SW.
PROX. SW.
CENTRAL
UNIT
AUTOMODE ON
K4
K5 NO
CRANE
INTERFACE
CONNECTOR
PROP.
ANALOG
OUTPUT
AI 1
ANALOG INPUT
P1
P2
A1
L1
ANALOG
INPUT
AI 2
CENTER MID LENGTH SENSOR
INNER MID LENGTH SENSOR
MAIN BOOM LENGTH SENSOR
ANGLE SENSOR
ROD PRESS. TRANS.
PISTON PRESS. TRANS.
LMI CONSOLE
22.2
Sequence valve
The sequence valve maintains pressure on the rod side to prevent the cylinders from extending
when
the trombone tubes are pressurized.
* If the boom sections drift back in momentarily after the controller is released, this is a good
indication
the sequence valve is defective.
* To adjust or check for proper adjustment:
1. Install gauge into test port between pressure reducing valve and sequence valve.
2. Select manual mode.
3. Select either inner mid or center mid section.
4. Extend the boom section and monitor pressure while boom is extending. If it does not
read 1,000 P.S.I., adjust valve accordingly.
Pressure reducing valve
The pressure reducing valve is used to flood the rod side whenever the telescope cylinders first
begin to extend.
* If the boom sections take off with a jump, this is a good indication the pressure reducing valve
is defective.
* To adjust or check for proper adjustment:
1. Always be sure to check setting of the sequence valve first.
2. Gauge should still be in test port from checking sequence valve.
3. With manual mode still selected.
4. Select either the inner mid or center mid section chosen.
5. Extend the section completely until it bottoms out.
6. Release controller or treadle valve to neutral (this allows oil to drain off).
7. Then operate controller or treadle valve to extend and note pressure reading, it should
read 800 P.S.I. if it does not, adjust pressure reducing valve accordingly.
Check valve
The purpose of the check valve, is to prevent high pressure oil from flowing back through the
800 P.S.I. pressure reducing valve when trying to retract.
22.3
HELPFUL HINTS
CHECKING THE COILS IN THE TWO WAY VALVES FOR CONTINUITY
1. Select manual mode
2. Select individual sections to operate.
3. If there is continuity in the wiring to the valve, the section lights will illuminate.
22.4
VIEW A - A
VIEW B - B
22.5
CRANE ELECTRIC
INTERFACE CONNECTION
CENTRAL UNIT
FUSE ( 10A)
FUSE ( 4A )
P.A.T. - LMI
RT865 BXL (BCS)
TURNTABLE COMPONENTS
BOOM CONTROL
BUS EXTENSION
B PAT B
RT865BXL
CONNECTIONS FOR
TURNTABLE HARDWARE
TO BOOM HARDWARE
19 - pin plug
14 - pin plug
7 - pin plug
RT865BXL (BCS)
Central Processing Unit
A 102 CPU
MODULE
SYSTEM
E-PROM
A 105 SERIAL
EXTENSION
MODULE
SYS
A 103 E-PROM
MODULE
DATA
DATA E-PROM
TLK
A 101 MAIN
BOARD
TLK E-PROM
LMI
BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
K8
K10
K9
A 106 ANALOG
INPUT MODULE
RELAYS
X1 TERMINAL
STRIP
FERRITE
FILTER
4 AMP
10 AMP
RT865BXL (BCS)
Bus Extension
A 104 PV
EXTENSION
MODULE
A102 CPU
MODULE
4 AMP
FUSE
X1
TERMINAL
X1
TERMINAL
A 105 ANALOG
INPUT
MODULE
2 AMP
FUSE
X2
TERMINAL
A 101 BUS
EXTENSION
K1-K8
RELAYS
22.6
A 104 PV
Extension
Module
A 105 Analog
Input Module
A 102 CPU
Module
25
2
26
8
72
A 101
Bus Extension
22.7
RT865BXL
with Boom Control
Turntable Components
22.8
RT865BXL (BCS)
Relay Outputs
INPUT
K1
K2
CU
DESCRIPTION
TERMINAL
A101 BUS
NOT USED
X1/3
A101 BUS
X1/5
NOTES
NONE
K3
A101 BUS
X1/8
K4
A101 BUS
X1/12
K5
A101 BUS
X1/13
K5
A101 BUS
X1/14
K5
A101 BUS
X1/15
K6
A101 BUS
X1/17
K7
A101 MAIN
VALVES (2) PILOT PRESSURE
X1/20
PISTON SIDE PRESSURE
K8
A101 MAIN
LM I CUT OFF INTERNAL RELAY
X1/9
K9
A101 MAIN
A2B CUT OFF INTERNAL RELAY
X1/8
K10
A101 MAIN
LM I UNLOCK RELAY OUTPUT
X1/12
K10
A101 MAIN
EXTERNAL ALARM OUTPUT
X1/13
22.9
6
7
TELE ROD DRAIN
16
8
9
10
A104
X1
1
2
3
4
11
TELE OUT OF SEQUENCE 13
ANALOG SIGNAL
12
13
17
14
18
15
16
CM TELE
17
18
19
OM / FLY TELE
TELE
PROP.
ANALOG
GND.
20
21
22
23
24
26
H17
>
K2
>
K3
H19
22.10
2A - F4
>
K4
H20 TELE SEQUENCE
2A - F5
>
K5
NO PROP. EXT.
H21 NC PROP. RET.
2A - F6
>
K6
H22
+24V CM 2WAYS
2A - F7
>
K7
+24V OM 2WAYS
H23
2A - F8
>
K8
H24
+UB
10 - 35V
27
28
+24V IM 2WAYS
H18
25
K1
2A - F3
>
>
>
>
>
>
IM TELE
>
2A - F2
>
>
>
>
>
>
2A - F1
>
>
>
>
X1
KGND
RT865BXL (BCS)
DS350Graphic Modular
Automode control of two way valves
K2
0
1
1
0
0
K6
1
0
1
0
0
K7
1
1
0
0
0
DESCRIPTION
IM EXTENDING OR RETRACTING
CM EXTENDING OR RETRACTING
OM/FLY EXTENDING OR RETRACTING
OUT OF SEQUENCE
NEUTRAL POSITION
Analog Outputs
ANALOG
1
1
CU
DESCRIPTION
TERMINAL
A104 X1/2 Analog GND for proportional extend or retract solenoid valves.
A104 X1/1 Analog signal for proportional extend or retract solenoid valves.
Ext.
DI 1
1
0
Retr.
DI 2
0
1
Relay
K2
0
0
Relay
K6
1
1
Relay
K7
1
1
Relay
K5
1
0
2 way
IM
0
0
2 way
CM
1
1
2 way
OM
1
1
analog
output
1
1
Auto CM
Auto CM
Auto OM
Auto OM
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
0
1
0
1
Man. IM
Man. IM
Man. CM
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
Man. CM
Man. OM
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
Man. OM
Neutral
Mode
Logic 1 ON - 0 OFF
IM%
0
50
50
75
75
100
100
100
CM%
0
0
50
50
75
75
100
100
22.11
OM%
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
100
FLY%
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
100
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 23
PAT
PAT
PAT
3
5
23.1
1
See detail
A
See detail
C
CM length sensor
LG321
Boom length & angle sensor
LWG309
IM % reset
switch
See detail
C
23.2
PAT
PAT
PAT
See detail
C
OM retract and %
reset switch
IM retract
switch
CM retract and %
reset switch
See detail
B
16
18
0.44
0.44
16
See detail
A
0.44
18
3.94
CENTER LINE OF
TARGETS &
PROXIMITY SW.
23.3
0.13
PAT
DETAIL A
1.0
DETAIL C
1.34
DETAIL B
To
wi be a
t
l
of h ce igne
c a nt e d
ble
r
ree line
ld
rum
19
23.4
CENTER LINE OF CABLE GUIDES
CENTER LINE OF
CABLE REEL DRUM
19
P1
J1
AGND
MP14
ERROR
CODE
E11
.500v MIN.
MP7 - MP1->
MP16
16
1
2
AGND
1
2
BR1
X1
AGND
20
40
23.5
VOLTAGES
X1 3 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL (RETRACTED BOOM)
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL (10 TURNS ON POT)
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 28) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
X1 26 27 28
WORKING
RANGE
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
4.50v MAX. A
ERROR
CODE
(GND)
P2
LENGTH
P3
MP9
VREFA
P4
+UB
MP12
P5
Channel # 1
OPERATING WINDOW
.0V
MP17
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E21
5.0V
2 3
E11 / E21
6 Pin
GND
7 8 5 3 1
X2
X4
+UB
5 3 1
5 3 1
+UB
1 OUT
CORE
GND
SHIELD
1 OUT
5 3 1
X3
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
6 5
7
4 3 2 1
Plug
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6 Pin
Connector
X1
1
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
IS = CUT&INSULATE
7
X2
RED
SHEILD
CORE
X1
BRN
SHIELD
A
B
CORE
1
2
X4
5
SIG. 3
+24V 1
23.6
1 2 3 4
3
2
GND
SIG.
+24V
1
2
X3
5
3
3
4
7 - PIN PLUG
X1
SIG
A 1
B 2
C 3
D 4
G 7
LG
4.7K
GND
CH #1
CH #5
IS = CUT&INSULATE
1
2
3
4
OS Connected
to strain relief
insert
5
6
7
IS = CUT
&INSULATE
4A
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
14
10A
= CONNECTED
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
+ +24V
K10A
0V
+ +UBS
0V
RXD
TXD
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
+ +UBS
K9
K8
F2- 10A
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
DE 2
17
DE 3
18
DE 4
19
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
+ +UBS
26
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG 1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
A2B-I
58
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
+ +UBS
64
0V
65
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
+UBS
+
76
0V
77
K10B
X4
BRN
1
2 WHT
PNK
3 GRA
4
5 GRN
6 YEL
WHT
WHT
BRN
BRN
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
YEL
GRN
3-Pair
Twisted
Cable
GRA
PNK
X2
1
2
GRN
3
YEL
4
5
6
PNK
7
GRA
8
BRN
WHT
BUS EXTENSION
13
+UBS
MAIN BOARD
WG
GND
X2
F1
STOP
W # 71K = 24 VOLTS
+UB
RT865BXL (BCS)
Cable Reel LWG309
PAT
PAT
PAT
23.7
Ratio = 3.75 to 1
(PRE - TENSION ON CABLE REEL = 10 REVOLUTIONS COUNTERCLOCKWISE)
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
X2
X1
9333103309
7 (9)
8 (10)
Complete Assembly
Board, Terminal w/ filters
Angle Sensor WG103/0007
Length Potentiometer
Length Cable (single core, 63M - 206 ft.)
Slip Ring Assem. 2-pole
1
1
1
9-333-103394
9-333-103309
9-333-103303
9-333-103308
9-333-102382
9-333-102732
23.8
CHANNEL # 1
RT865BXL (BCS)
Cable Reel LG321
PAT
PAT
PAT
23.9
XA2
1
1
9-333-103621
9-333-101777
9-333-101617
1
1
1
9-333-102490
9-333-102737
9-333-101778
9-333-103752
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Ratio = 2 to 1
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
A
X2
7 (9)
8 (10)
X1
X1
11
12
13
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
14
15
16
9333103309
17
18
19
X1
TO
JUCTION
BOX - IM
14
20
WHT/BLK
19
19
10
BLK
18
18
11
BLK
WHT
WHT
17
17
GRA
GRA
16
16
VIO
VIO
15
15
BLU
BLU
14
14
GRN
13
13
10
GRN
YEL
YEL
12
12
ORG
ORG
11
11
8
5
14
10
S
RED
BRN
BRN
X2
LG
23.10
12
X3
X1
S
14 - SOCKET
PLUG
R
14
14
P
13
13
N
12
12
M
11
11
L
10
10
K
9
9
J
8
8
H
7
7
G
6
6
3
F
5
5
E
4
4
D
3
3
1
C
2
2
B
1
1
A
A104
X1
1
2
3
4
1
3
3
5
9
10
12
7
1
4
6
13
14
TO
JUCTION
BOX - BOOM BASE
K3 COM ( +24V )
K3 NO ( +24V TELE ROD DRAIN SOL. )
K3 NC
K4 COM
K4 NO
K4 NC ( TELE OUT OF SEQUENCE )
K5 COM
K5 NO ( PROP EXT )
K5 NC ( PROP RET )
K6 COM ( + 24V )
K6 NO ( +24V TO CM 2-WAY SOLS. )
K6 NC
K7 COM ( +24V )
K7 NO ( +24V TO OM 2-WAY SOLS. )
K7 NC
+24V
+24V
GND
GND
DI 1 ( +24V = TELE EXT. PRESS. SW. )
DI 1 GND
DI 2 ( +24V = TELE RET. PRESS. SW. )
DI 2 GND
DI 3 ( +24V = AUTO MODE )
DI 3 GND
DI 4 ( +24V = OM / FLY RET )
DI 4 GND
DI 5 ( +24V = CM RET & % RESET )
DI 5 GND
DI 6 ( +24V = IM RET )
DI 6 GND
DI 7 ( +24V = IM % RESET )
DI 7 GND
X2
1 BRN
2 WHT
GRN
3 YEL
4
ANALOG INPUT 1 (IM LEN.)
5
ANALOG INPUT 2 (CM LEN.) 6
7 PNK
8 GRA
WHT
BRN
WHT
YEL
GRN
BRN
GRA
PNK
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
X4
1
WHT
2
PNK
3
GRA
4
GRN
5
YEL
6
BRN
MAIN BOARD
K2 COM ( +24V )
K2 NO ( +24V TO IM 2-WAY SOLS. )
BUS EXTENSION
WHT/BLK
11
13
RED
8
11
PV EXTENSION
20
V
U
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
RT865BXL (BCS)
Cable Reel LG321
PAT
PAT
PAT
23.11
Ratio = 1 to 1
(PRE - TENSION ON CABLE REEL = 30 REVOLUTIONS COUNTERCLOCKWISE)
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
A
X2
7 (9)
8 (10)
X1
X1
11
12
13
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
14
15
16
9333103309
17
18
19
Complete Assembly
Board, Terminal w/ filters
Length Potentiometer
Length Cable (eleven core, 33.5 M - 110 ft.)
Slip Ring Assem. 11 pole
Junction Box
Gear Wheel
1
1
9-333-103620
9-333-101777
9-333-101617
1
1
1
9-333-102490
9-333-102737
9-333-101778
9-333-102982
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 24
X1
1
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
PISTON TRANSDUCER
3
4
IS = CUT& INSULATE
B 2
5
1
C 3
1
2
3
1
2
3
CH #2
24.1
CH #3
ROD TRANSDUCER
DAVS 314
A 1
OS Connected
to strain relief
insert
B 2
1
C 3
4A
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
14
10A
= CONNECTED
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
+ +24V
K10A
0V
+ +UBS
0V
RXD
TXD
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
+ +UBS
K9
K8
F2- 10A
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
DE 2
17
DE 3
18
DE 4
19
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
+ +UBS
26
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG 1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
A2B-I
58
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
+ +UBS
64
0V
65
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
+UBS
+
76
0V
77
K10B
X4
BRN
1
2 WHT
PNK
3 GRA
4
5 GRN
6 YEL
WHT
WHT
BRN
BRN
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
YEL
GRN
3-Pair
Twisted
Cable
GRA
PNK
X2
1
2
GRN
3
YEL
4
5
6
PNK
7
GRA
8
BRN
WHT
BUS EXTENSION
13
+UBS
MAIN BOARD
DAVS 314
A 1
F1
10
STOP
W # 71K = 24 VOLTS
+UB
AGND
MP14
ERROR
CODE
J1
E12
.500v MIN.
MP7 - MP1->
MP16
16
1
2
AGND
1
2
BR1
X1
AGND
20
40
24.2
VOLTAGES
X1 1 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL (ZERO PRESSURE)
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL (300 BAR PRESSURE)
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 22) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
X1 20 21 22
-
WORKING
RANGE
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
4.50v MAX.
ERROR
CODE
(GND)
P1
(PISTON)
P2
+UB
P3
MP9
VREFA
P4
OUTPUT SIGNAL
MP12
P5
Channel # 2
OPERATING WINDOW
.0V
MP17
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E22
5.0V
2 3 4
E12 / E22
(measurements at transducer)
Measure Voltage - (Elec) Piston transducer at A (+) & C (-)
Range 10V to 30V
Measure Voltage - (Elec) Piston transducer at B (+) & C (-)
Range 0V
1 2 3 4
A B C
A B C
AGND
MP14
ERROR
CODE
J1
E13
.500v MIN.
MP7 - MP1->
MP16
16
1
2
24.3
VOLTAGES
X1 2 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = MIN. SIGNAL (ZERO PRESSURE)
+ 4.50V = MAX. SIGNAL (300 BAR PRESSURE)
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 25) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
E13 / E23
4.50v MAX.
AGND
1
2
BR1
X1
AGND
20
40
X1 23 24 25
-
WORKING
RANGE
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
ERROR
CODE
(GND)
P1
(ROD)
P2
+UB
P3
MP9
VREFA
P4
OUTPUT SIGNAL
MP12
P5
Channel # 3
OPERATING WINDOW
.0V
MP17
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E23
5.0V
2 3 4
(measurements at transducer)
Measure Voltage - (Elec) Rod transducer at A (+) & C (-)
Range 10V to 30V
Measure Voltage - (Elec) Rod transducer at B (+) & C (-)
Range 0V
1 2 3 4
A B C
A B C
+24.0
+0
A
B
24.4
PAT
The first step is to lower the boom all the way down
(blocking the boom), shut the engine off then disconnect
hydraulic hose from the piston or rod side pressure
transducer.
DS 350
STOP
STOP
TARE
!
LIM
ENTER YOUR
SERVICE CODE
SEL
5 5 5 5 5
STOP
>
F2
F3
STOP
F1
(1)
(2)
CTRL
F4
PAT
DS 350
STOP
0
STOP
TARE
!
LIM
SEL
STOP
-4%
-2%
0%
+2%
+4%
AUTO
0
CTRL
ESC
STOP
F1
F2
F3
F4
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 25
X1
1
2
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
IS = CUT&INSULATE
7
X2
RED
SHEILD
CORE
X1
BRN
SHIELD
A
B
CORE
1
2
X4
5
SIG. 3
+24V 1
25.1
1 2 3 4
3
2
GND
SIG.
+24V
1
2
X3
5
3
3
4
7 - PIN PLUG
X1
SIG
A 1
B 2
C 3
D 4
G 7
LG
4.7K
GND
CH #1
CH #5
IS = CUT&INSULATE
1
2
3
4
OS Connected
to strain relief
insert
5
6
7
IS = CUT
&INSULATE
4A
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
14
10A
= CONNECTED
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
+ +24V
K10A
0V
+ +UBS
0V
RXD
TXD
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
+ +UBS
K9
K8
F2- 10A
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
DE 2
17
DE 3
18
DE 4
19
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
+ +UBS
26
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG 1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
A2B-I
58
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
+ +UBS
64
0V
65
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
+UBS
+
76
0V
77
K10B
X4
BRN
1
2 WHT
PNK
3 GRA
4
5 GRN
6 YEL
WHT
WHT
BRN
BRN
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
YEL
GRN
3-Pair
Twisted
Cable
GRA
PNK
X2
1
2
GRN
3
YEL
4
5
6
PNK
7
GRA
8
BRN
WHT
BUS EXTENSION
13
+UBS
MAIN BOARD
WG
GND
X2
F1
STOP
W # 71K = 24 VOLTS
+UB
J1
AGND
MP14
ERROR
CODE
.500v MIN.
1
2
MP16
16
1
2
25.2
VOLTAGES
X1 4 ANALOG INPUT MODULE
+ 500MV (.500V) = 90o ANGLE MIN. SIGNAL
+ 2.50V = 45o ANGLE
+ 4.5 V = 0o ANGLE MAX. SIGNAL
ALL VOTAGES ARE MEASURED WITH
REFERENCE TO GND (TERMINAL X1 - 28) ON MAIN BOARD.
* THESE MEASUREMENTS ARE MADE IN PARALLEL
E15 / E25
X1 26 28 29
WORKING
RANGE
AGND
BR1
20
40
X1
AGND
E15
MP7 - MP1->
- +
MP11
MP10
J2
4.50v MAX.
ERROR
CODE
(90o TO 0o)
P1
ANGLE
P2
(GND)
P3
MP9
VREFA
P4
+UB
MP12
P5
Channel # 5
OPERATING WINDOW
.0V
MP17
P6
MP13
MP0
MP8
- +
AGND
P7
P8
E25
5.0V
SHIELD
CORE
3 4
6 Pin
Plug
7 8 5 3 1
X2
X4
+UB
1 OUT
5 3 1
GND
+UB
GND
1 OUT
5 3 1
5 3 1
X3
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
6 5
7
4 3 2 1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
6 Pin
Connector
SIGNAL AT X1 TERM.
PIN #29 ON C.P.U.
TERMINAL
4.0 mA
SIGNAL ON ANALOG
MODULE AT X1-4
(X1-28 GND.)
0.48
85o
4.9 mA
+ .70
5.7 mA
+ .92
75o
6.6 mA
+ 1.15
70o
7.4 mA
+ 1.37
8.3 mA
+ 1.60
60o
9.2 mA
+ 1.80
80
65
25.3
55
10.2 mA
+ 2.04
50
11.2 mA
+ 2.26
45o
12.1 mA
+ 2.48
40o
12.9 mA
+ 2.70
35o
13.7 mA
+ 2.92
14.7 mA
+ 3.15
25o
15.6 mA
+ 3.38
20o
16.5 mA
+ 3.60
17.3 mA
+ 3.82
10o
18.0 mA
+ 4.04
30
15
5
19.2 mA
+ 4.27
20 mA
+ 4.49
CHANNEL #5
RT865BXL (BCS)
Cable Reel LWG309
PAT
PAT
PAT
25.4
9-333-103303
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 26
To Central Unit
1
2
SHIELD
5 3 1
3 4
2
4
26.1
1
2
7 8 5 3 1
X2
X4
A
B
1 2 3 4 5 6
5 3 1
X3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
2
S 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 X1
1 2
1 2
1 2
6 5
3
Plug
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
5 3 1
+UB
6 Pin
GND
1 2
A B
GND
CORE
CORE
1 OUT
SHIELD
+UB
A
B
1 OUT
6 Pin
4 3 21
Connector
5
7
NO.
1
1 2
PART NO.
QTY
1
2
3
4
5
9-333-102764
9-333-102717
9-333-102666
9-333-102663
9-333-102230
1
1
1
4
1
9-333-102765
DESCRIP.
COMP. ASSEM.
2-POLE JUMPER BAR
TAGS, TERMINAL STRIP
BLOCK, TERMINAL STRIP
SWITCH A2B, WITH RETAINER
CRIMP
COMP. ASSEM., DUMMY PLUG
NOTES:
OUTER SHIELD GROUNDED AT
1
STRAIN RELIEF CONNECTOR
2
IMPORTANT CHANGE
10
CONSOLE
BY - PASS
KEY
3
4
8
5
4
3
26.2
AB
A2B
3
4
DATA TO C.U.
2
1
3
(GND) 2
(+24 V)
GRAPHIC CONSOLE
4A
13
14
10A
= CONNECTED
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
K10A
+ +UBS
0V
RXD
TXD
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
+ +UBS
K9
K8
F2- 10A
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
DE 2
17
DE 3
18
DE 4
19
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
+ +UBS
26
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG 1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
A2B-I
58
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
+ +UBS
64
0V
65
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
+UBS
+
76
0V
77
K10B
X4
BRN
1
2 WHT
PNK
3 GRA
4
5 GRN
6 YEL
WHT
WHT
BRN
BRN
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
YEL
GRN
3-Pair
Twisted
Cable
GRA
PNK
X2
1
2
GRN
3
YEL
4
5
6
PNK
7
GRA
8
BRN
WHT
BUS EXTENSION
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
+ +24V
0V
MAIN BOARD
LMI
+UBS
W # 71K = 24 VOLTS
F1
STOP
W # 51AJ = GND
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
+UB
X1
1
2
NO.
PART NO.
QTY
1
2
9-333-102238
9-333-102956
1
1
3+
9-333-102768
26.3
DESCRIPTION
SWITCH, A2B W/O CRIMP
CONDUIT 3 FEET
(MUST CUT TO LENGTH)
JUNCTION BOX ASSEM.
1(BLACK)
1
2(BROWN)
A2B CABLE
3(RED)
2
3
PART NO.
QTY
9-333-102758
9-333-102764
9-333-101984
9-333-102759
9-333-102663
9-333-102664
9-333-102665
9-333-102666
9-333-102760
9-333-102482
9-333-102612
9-333-102669
9-333-102266
9-333-102480
1
1
1
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
4
4
4
DESCRIPTION
Junction Box
Strain Relief
Locknut
Mounting rail, terminal strip
Block, terminal strip
End plate, terminal strip
End bracket, terminal strip
Tags, terminal strip
Connector, cannon 2-pin male recp.
Gasket
Cover, dust
Screw #4
Lockwasher #4
Nut #4
26.4
Folding Extension
4
2
26.5
1
NO.
1
2
PART NO.
9-333-102230
9-333-102956
QTY
1
1
3+
4+
9-333-102996
9-333-102766
1
1
DESCRIPTION
Switch, A2B W/O Crimp
Conduit 10 feet
(must cut to length)
Junction box assembly
Junction box assembly
Folding Extension
JUNCTION BOX ASSEMBLY
1(BLACK)
1
A2B CABLE
2(BROWN)
3(RED)
2
3
PART NO.
9-333-102758
9-333-101995
9-333-102759
9-333-102663
9-333-102664
9-333-102665
9-333-102666
9-333-102760
9-333-102482
9-333-102612
9-333-102669
9-333-102266
9-333-102480
QTY
DESCRIPTION
1
1
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
4
4
4
Junction Box
Strain Relief
Mounting rail, terminal strip
Block, terminal strip
End plate, terminal strip
End bracket, terminal strip
Tags, terminal strip
Connector, cannon 2-pin male recp.
Gasket
Cover, dust
Screw #4
Lockwasher #4
Nut #4
26.6
Folding Extension
JUNCTION BOX ASSEMBLY
PART NO.
9-333-102758
9-333-101995
9-333-101984
9-333-102664
9-333-102663
9-333-102664
9-333-102665
9-333-103044
9-333-102792
9-333-102482
9-333-102612
9-333-102669
9-333-102266
9-333-102480
QTY
DESCRIPTION
1
1
1
1
3
1
2
1
1
1
1
4
4
4
26.7
Junction Box
Strain Relief
Locknut
Mounting Rail
Block, terminal strip
End plate, terminal strip
End bracket, terminal strip
Tags, terminal strip
Connector, cannon 2-pin male recp.
Gasket
Cover, dust
Screw #4
Lockwasher #4
Nut #4
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 27
RT865BXL (BCS)
MAIN & BUS EXTENSION
DIGITAL INPUTS
INPUT
BUS EXT.
1
2
3
5
6
7
CU
DESCRIPTION
TERMINAL
A101 BUS
TELE EXTEND (+24V)
X1/29
A101 BUS
TELE RETRACT (+24V)
X1/31
A101 BUS
AUTO MODE SELECTED (+24V)
X1/33
A101 BUS
X1/35
A101 BUS
X1/37
A101 BUS
X1/39
A101 BUS
X1/41
NOTES
GROVE PRESSURE SWITCH SIGNAL
GROVE PRESSURE SWITCH SIGNAL
GROVE SELECTOR SWITCH SIGNAL
PAT SWITCH ON CM - SIGNAL VIA CM
CABLE REEL
INPUT
MAIN
2
3
27.1
X1
25
26
+UB
10 - 35V
27
KGND
28
TELE EXT. PRESS. SW.
23 pin
plug
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
12
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
27.2
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
>
DE 1
DE 2
DE 3
DE 4
DE 5
DE 6
DE 7
DE 8
DE 9
H1
+24V TELEEXT.
PRESS. SW.
H2
+24V TELERET.
PRESS. SW.
+24V AUTO MODE
H3
H4
+24V OM / FLY
RET.
H5
H6
+24V IM % RESET.
H7
H8
H9
DE 10
H10
DE 11
H11
DE 12
H12
DE 13
H13
DE 14
H14
DE 15
H15
DE 16
H16
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 28
G1
+UB1
PWM DC
MP42
KGND
MP 26
KGND
MP 4
+5V
MP 9
+6V
X15
GND
GND
AGND
KGND
MP24
MP23
VBAT
+BATT
MP 8
+9V
GND
5
+UB1 +UB
DI 6
KGND
X12
MP40
V10 H11 V11 MP41
H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6
DI 1
MP21
PFAIL+UB1
DI 1- DI 6 =>
X17
power o.k.
X14
J11
X11
SP5
X13
X16
TXD
H12
K8
10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K10
A2B
+UB
MP29
K9
KGND
F
1
H9
A2B
69 68 67
66
65 64
63 62
61 60 59 58
57 56
55 54
KGND
3
1
77 76
KGND
KGND
11
J4
J3
J2
J1
X1
12
F
2
11
X1
13
AGND
H10
2
1
MAIN
ON/OFF
KGND
J10
3
4
LMI
KGND
10
LOAD
+5V/RS232
AGND
12
KGND
MP1
+UBS
36 35 34 33
32 31
30 29 28 27 26
25 24 23
22 21 20
19 18 17 16 15 14
13 12 11
10 9
MP 25
LOCATIONS :
LEDS
H 8 - zone M3 - LOAD
H 9 - zone E11 - A2B
H 10 - zone G9 -MAIN IN/ OUT
H 11 - zone M3 - POWER
H 12 - zone I11 - TXD
28.1
13
MP7
J1
J13
J12
J2
D3
D1
MP4
D2
X1
D14
X2
D13
P1
SYSTEM
D10
J8
D6
J9 MP3 J6
D17
J10
D15
D7
D21
D9
D12
J15
J11
J14
D18
J7
D11
D19
D20
X3
BR6
MP6MP5
EJECT
BR5
MP2
A102 CPU
J1
J2
DATA
D1
J5
J3
TLK
D3
J6
BR
4
3
2
1
X1
A103 DATEN
28.2
P7
MP12
1
2
40
AGND
AGND
-
P6
MP13
J2
20
P5
16
P4
P3
MP9
J1
MP11
X16
P2
MP10
P1
1 1
2
X1
MP17
BR1
MP0
MP8
VREFA
P8
MP7 - MP1->
X17
1
2
MP16
16
6 5
4 3
MP14
2 1
40
1
2
AGND
AGND
= ADC INPUT 0.5V 4.5 V, Note: If channel adjustments are made through
the software and graphic console, DO NOT adjust offset with P1 - P7
= TEMP (0.5V + 10mV/oC)
= VREFA = 5.000V reference
MP 1 = AGND
= AGND (reference GND)
MP 8 = + 5V
= VREF+ = 5.0V power ADC
MP 1 - 7 Input channels 1 - 7 - 0.5V / 4 mA
= CH01-04, DIN 1-4 / 10
2.5V / 20mA
= CH05, +UBS / 10
MP 14 = + 13V REF 02
= CH06, HESIN(A2B) *4
MP 16 = HESIN input voltage
= CH07, +9V *4
MP 17 = app 5.4V clamp for inputs
= CH08, VREFA / 2 = 2.500V
= UKLEMM, app. VREFA, limits ADC input to 5.0V
28.3
KGND
MP1
MP10
F5 F4
2A 2A
MP15
MP4 H1 H2 MP3
X4
1 2 3 4 5 6
C30
MP0
GND
MP16
MP1
1
2
3
4
5
6
H3
DI 9
MP14
ADC
2 3
5 6
8 9
10 11 12
13 14 15
16 17 18
19 20 21
22 23 24
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
X2
2A
F25
K1
K2
K3
K4
K5
K6
K7
F1
K8
F8
F2
H17
F3
H18
F4
H19
F5
H20
F6
H21
F7
H22
H23
H24
28.4
25 26 27 28
29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60
MP 2
MP9
MP 1
61 62 63 64 65 66
MP 8
UREL
MP 0
DI 1
+ 7V
C27
KGND AGND + UB
H8 H7 H6 H5 H4 H3 H2 H1
C93
DI 8
X4
MP4
C38
J3
C37
C32
SLAVE
E - PROM
MP2
C33
H1
MP0
MP1
MP3
J1
X2
P11
MP2
MP3
MP7
MP6
P12
MP0
X1
MP1
1 2 3 4
H1
MP5
28.5
MP4
RT865BXL (BCS)
BUS EXTENSION
INTERFACE
Grove wire
number
71H
51AK
Interface
connector
A
CRANE GND
387A
388
239B
242B
243B
244B
[507]
[505]
[338]
323A
O
P
Q
R
238A
1083
255A
257A
V
W
X
RT865BXL (BCS)
MAIN BOARD
INTERFACE
Grove wire
number
71K
51AJ
73A
74
744
Interface
connector
A
CRANE GND
F
G
H
28.6
W # 71K = 24 VOLTS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
1
3
4
13
14
10A
= CONNECTED
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
+ +24V
K10A
0V
+ +UBS
0V
RXD
TXD
A2B-O
A2B-I
LOAD-I
+ +UBS
K9
K8
F2- 10A
11 REL -M
12
REL -A
13
REL -R
14
+ +UBS
15
DE 1
16
DE 2
17
DE 3
18
DE 4
19
20
+ +UBS
I
21
DAV1
U
0V
22
23
+ +UBS
I
24
DAV2
U
0V
25
+ +UBS
26
I
27
LG 1
U
0V
28
I
29
WG 1
U
I
30
LG 1
U
31
0V
32
33
+ +UBS
I
34
S1 DHG 1
U
0V
35
I
36
S2 DHG 2
U
51
+ +UB
0V
52
F1 - 4A
53
SI - OUT
54
SI - IN
57
A2B-0
A2B-I
58
LOAD-I
59
60
+ +UBS
F2-10A
61
SI-REL
62
SI-REL
+ +UBS
64
0V
65
66
DE 5
67
68
DE 6
69
+UBS
+
76
0V
77
K10B
X4
BRN
1
2 WHT
PNK
3 GRA
4
5 GRN
6 YEL
WHT
WHT
BRN
BRN
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
YEL
GRN
3-Pair
Twisted
Cable
GRA
PNK
X2
1
2
GRN
3
YEL
4
5
6
PNK
7
GRA
8
BRN
WHT
BUS EXTENSION
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
+UBS
MAIN BOARD
28.7
4A
F1
W # 51AJ = GND
X1
STOP
1
2
+UB
X1
PV EXTENSION
16
A104
X1
1
2
3
4
13
15 17
18
8
7
+ 24V
GND
71H
51AK
387A
388
239B
242B
243B
244B
323A
238A
1083
255A
257A
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
1
2
1
4
5
6
7
8
9
2
4
5
6
13
15
16
17
18
LMI - CRANE INTERFACE
23 - PIN PLUG
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
K3 COM ( +24V )
K3 NO ( +24V TELE ROD DRAIN SOL. )
K3 NC
K4 COM
K4 NO
K4 NC ( TELE OUT OF SEQUENCE )
K5 COM
K5 NO ( PROP EXT )
K5 NC ( PROP RET )
K6 COM ( + 24V )
K6 NO ( +24V TO CM 2-WAY SOLS. )
K6 NC
K7 COM ( +24V )
K7 NO ( +24V TO OM 2-WAY SOLS. )
K7 NC
+24V
+24V
GND
GND
DI 1 ( +24V = TELE EXT. PRESS. SW. )
DI 1 GND
DI 2 ( +24V = TELE RET. PRESS. SW. )
DI 2 GND
DI 3 ( +24V = AUTO MODE )
DI 3 GND
DI 4 ( +24V = OM / FLY RET )
DI 4 GND
DI 5 ( +24V = CM RET & % RESET )
DI 5 GND
DI 6 ( +24V = IM RET )
DI 6 GND
DI 7 ( +24V = IM % RESET )
DI 7 GND
X2
1 BRN
2 WHT
GRN
3 YEL
4
ANALOG INPUT 1 (IM LEN.)
5
ANALOG INPUT 2 (CM LEN.) 6
7 PNK
8 GRA
WHT
BRN
WHT
YEL
GRN
BRN
GRA
PNK
YEL
GRA
GRN
PNK
X4
1
WHT
2
PNK
3
GRA
4
GRN
5
YEL
6
BRN
MAIN BOARD
K2 COM ( +24V )
K2 NO ( +24V TO IM 2-WAY SOLS. )
BUS EXTENSION
28.8
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65
66
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 29
General Flowchart
Lever Lockout Activated
Broken Length Cable
No Display
Anti - Two - Block
Length Reading Problem
Angle Reading Problem
Load Reading Problem
Bad Data Transfer Between Console & Central Unit
Error Code Displayed
29.1
29.2
29.3
29.4
29.5
29.7
29.10
29.37
29.40
29.42
29.45
GENERAL FLOWCHART
This section explains how to handle a problem that may arise with the P.A.T. Load Moment
Indicator System - P.A.T. DS350 Graphic Modular (BCS). The procedures are easy to follow
and are given in flowcharts on the following pages. Start with general flowchart below which
will guide you to one of the more detailed flowcharts shown on pages 35.3 through 35.45.
START
Whats Wrong?
Lever Lockout
Activated
Length Cable
Problem
No Display
Go to Page 29.3
Go to Page 29.4
Go to Page 29.5
Wrong Length
Displayed
Go to Page 29.10
Wrong Angle
Displayed
Wrong Load
Displayed
29.2
No Function
Anti-Two-Block
Go to Page 29.7
Bad Data
Transfer
Error Code
Displayed
Go to Page 29.42
Go to Page 29.45
START
fixed?
YES
NO
Does the console indicate
Anti-Two-Block warning?
NO
YES
If console displays is
blank, fault is located
in power supply,
wiring or fuses.
Fault in Anti-Two
Block system.
Go to page 29.5
Go to page 29.7
29.3
ACTION
Open cable reel cover and disconnect wiring from terminal block. Pull conductor
cable out of strain relief.
Remove damaged length cable, which is mounted to the slip rings in the cable reel,
from Terminal X1 and X2 See drawing 1 on page 29.53.
Turn the cable reel and open the stain relief attached to the axle in the center of the drum.
Pull existing length cable out of the cable reel.
Disconnect damaged length cable from Anti-Two-Block switch receptacle at the boom nose.
Pull new length cable through the hole, pipe and strain relief and push it through the axle of
the reeling drum. Tighten strain relief to ensure sealing.
Dismantle length cable near slip ring and reconnect shield to terminal No. X1 and center to
No. X2 See drawing 1 on page 29.53.
Remount cable reel to the boom. Turn reeling drum clockwise to get rest of new cable
onto the drum.
10
11
Reconnect new cable to Terminal No. 1 (center) and ground terminal (shield) of receptacle
at the boom nose.
12
29.4
NO DISPLAY
PROBLEM
Blank console display.
No warninglight shown.
Crane movements stopped.
START
Check fuses on CPU box.
correct?
NO
Replace fuses.
YES
Measure crane voltage on main board terminal
strip between X1-1(+12/24V) andX1-2 (ground).
This is an imput voltage from crane
Note: If crane voltage is measured below
10V system will switch off.
correct?
NO
YES
correct?
NO
YES
NEXT PAGE
29.5
NO DISPLAY
continued
PREVIOUS PAGE
correct?
NO
YES
END
29.6
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PROBLEM
Function of Anti-Two-Block System is faulty.
START
Check to see whether or not crane is in two-block condition.
NO
Lower hook down in safe position.
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
Measure the resistance at the boom nose
box between terminals 1 and 6 with
ohmmeter. This checks the function of the
Anti-Two-Block switch.
See drawing 2 on page 29.53.
Switch Closed = 4700 +/- 500 Ohms
Switch Open = > 1 Megaohm
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
29.7
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PREVIOUS PAGE
YES
YES
Measure the A2B signal in the boom base
box between terminal 5 and 6 with an ohmeter.
Anti-Two-Block switch open = > 1 megohm
Anti-Two-Block switch closed = 4700 Ohms
+ 500 Ohms.
Reconnect length cable to slip ring.
NO
Fault in 7 conductor cable between
correct?
cable reel and boom base box.
YES
NEXT PAGE
29.8
ANTI-TWO-BLOCK PROBLEM
PREVIOUS PAGE
Connect wire # 5 back to terminal X1-31
on the main board.
Turn system power off. Check Anti-Two-Block
signal in central unit with ohmmeter measure
between X1-31 and X1-32.
Anti-Two-Block switch closed = 4700 Ohms
+ 500 Ohms
Anti-Two-Block switch open = > 1 Megohm.
NO
correct?
YES
Disconnect X1-31 and X1-32.
Check main board function by installing a
temporary resistor, 4700 Ohms, between X131 and X1-32 in central unit. With resistor
connected alarm should be inactive.
NO
correct?
END
29.9
Wrong?
No
Yes
IM and/ or CM retract signal not recognized. Check
proximity switch target adjustment. Refer to Drawing
on page 23.3. If damage is visible install new switch.
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the voltage supply to IM switch at terminal
1 (+24V) and 3 (GND) in the length transducer LG321.
NEXT PAGE
29.10
Correct?
No
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure voltage at terminal 1 (+24V) and 5
(GND) in the IM junction box. Behind drum.
Correct?
No
Faulty wiring between length
transducer and LG 321 and IM
junction box. Check wiring.
Yes
NEXT PAGE
29.11
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the IM reset switch signal at wire 2
(+ 24)(fast-on connector) and terminal 3 (GND)
in the length transducer LG321. See page 29.4.
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the IM retract switch signal at terminal 4
(+ 24) and terminal 5 (GND) in the length switch
junction box on base boom. See page 29.5.
NEXT PAGE
29.12
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the IM reset switch signal at wire 4
(+ 24)(fast-on connector) and 3 (GND)
in the length transducer LG321. See page 29.4
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the CM retract switch signal at
terminal 6 (+ 24) and terminal 5 (GND)
in the IM junction box. See page 29.5
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the CM retract switch signal at
terminal 8 (+ 24) and terminal 3 (GND)
in the LG321. See page 29.4
NEXT PAGE
29.13
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the IM retract switch signal at terminal 39
(+24V) and 27 (GND) in the bus extension.
See page 29.3
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the IM reset switch signal at terminal 41
(+24V) and 27 (GND) in the bus extension.
See page 29.3
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the CM retract switch signal at terminal 37
(+24V) and 27 (GND) in the bus extension. See page 29.3
Correct?
No
Yes
NEXT PAGE
29.14
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure at CM junction box terminal 11 (+24V)
and 9 (GND). See page 29.5
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure OM retract switch signal at CM junction
box terminal 10 (+24V) and 9 (GND). See page 29.5
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure signal at terminal X1/8 (+24V) and X1/7
(GND) in the LG 321 (CM). See page 29.4
NEXT PAGE
29.15
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure signal at bus extension terminal X1/35
(+24V) and X1/27 (GND). See page 29.3
Correct?
No
Yes
Digital input defective on bus extention. Check
LEDs on bus extension. Follow replacement
procedures.
END
29.16
Correct?
No
Yes
Inspect the spooling of the length cable on all three drums.
Correct?
No
Yes
Remove the lid from the length transducers LWG 309
and both LG 321. Carefully reset the length transducer
potentiometer. Repeat testing the boom sequence in
automode.
NEXT PAGE
29.17
Failed?
No
Yes
In manual mode retract the boom. Disengage the boom stop block
to retract all section completely. Re-check the length potentiometer
adjustment.
Correct?
END
No
Yes
Remove lid from LG321 (IM length) and measure
supply voltage at terminal X1/1 (+24V) and X1/3
(GND). See page 29.4
Correct?
No
Yes
Failure in bus extension.
Check connectors, fuses
and bus extension power
supply.
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
29.19
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
Correct?
No
Yes
NEXT PAGE
29.20
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
29.21
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
Correct?
No
Yes
NEXT PAGE
29.22
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
29.23
No
Correct?
Yes
No
Correct?
Yes
29.24
Yes
Correct?
END
No
END
29.25
E83 ?
No
Yes
Switch to auto mode and retract the boom (Caution
Reduced load chart with E83)
E83 ?
No
Defect is not located in LMI
circuit. Refer to crane service
documentation to continue.
Yes
NEXT PAGE
29.26
Correct?
No
Yes
Correct?
Yes
No
Adjust the switch and the target.
Yes
Measure the voltage at terminal 25
(+24V) and terminal 27 (GND) in
the bus extension. See page 29.3
NEXT PAGE
29.27
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure OM retract switch power supply at LG 321
(CM) terminal X1/11 (+24V) and X1/7 (GND)
See page 29.4
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure OM retract switch signal at CM junction
box terminal 10 (+24V) and 9 (GND) See page 29.5
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure signal at LG 321(CM) terminal X1/8
(+24V) and X1/7 (GND). See page 29.4
NEXT PAGE
29.28
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure signal at bus extension terminal X1/35
(+24V) and X1/27 (GND) See page 29.3
Correct?
No
Yes
Digital input defective on bus extension. Check
LEDs on bus extension. Contact Technical
Support for replacement procedure.
END
29.29
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the power supply at the bus extension
terminal X1/26 (+24V) and 28 (GND). See page 29.3
Correct?
No
Yes
Faulty crane electric wiring.
Check wiring.
NEXT PAGE
29.30
Correct?
No
Yes
Check the bus extension cable wiring and
connections between bus extension and central
unit.
Correct?
No
Yes
If damage is visible replace the cable,
otherwise rewire and tighten the
connections. CAUTION: Twisted pairs
must remain twisted.
END
29.31
Error:
No tele-function at all in
automode.
Correct?
No
Yes
Correct?
No
Faulty crane eletric wiring.
Yes
Switch to auto mode. Start the engine. Operate the
extend control. Measure the extend signal at bus
extension terminal X1/29 (+24V) and X1/28 (GND).
See page 29.3
NEXT PAGE
29.32
Correct?
No
Yes
Operate the retract control. Measure the retract signal
at bus extension terminal X1/31 (+24V) and X1/28 (GND).
Correct?
No
Yes
Correct?
No
Yes
Select boom service screen on console.
Operate the retract control. The ramp value
for the appropriate section should increase
in steps from 0 to 255.
NEXT PAGE
29.33
Correct?
No
Yes
Select manual mode. Retract all sections. Switch power
off. Remove wire 2 from the analog output board terminal
Faulty digital input 2 on bus
A 104 X1/2 (IM). Switch power on. Operate retract and
extension. Contact Technical
extend control. Measure the electrical current (mA) between
Support for replacement procedure.
the wire 2 (removed from terminal) and the terminal X1/2.
The signal should increase from 0 mA to approximately 800 mA.
NOTE : In the ramping area the value may be < 800 mA.
Correct?
No
Yes
Faulty wiring in bus
extension. Check
wiring.
No
Correct?
Yes
NEXT PAGE
NEXT PAGE
29.34
PREVIOUS PAGE
Correct?
Yes
Correct?
Yes
NEXT PAGE
29.35
Correct?
No
Yes
Measure the two way valve signal (>/= +20V)
at terminal 1 or 2 (IM junction box) and terminal
1 or 2 and 3 or 4 (CM junction box).
Correct?
No
Yes
Faulty crane wiring or valve coil.
Refer to Crane Service Documentation.
END
29.36
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
29.37
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
29.38
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
END
29.39
correct?
YES
Check boom length reading on display.
NO
correct?
YES
Measure radius and check with the
displayed radius.
NO
correct?
YES
NO
correct?
YES
correct?
NO
NEXT PAGE
correct?
YES
YES
NO
correct?
YES
END
29.41
NO
correct?
YES
Measure process voltage on the main board in the
central unit between MP24 (+5V) and MP0 (GND).
NO
correct?
Off
YES
Turn off system power. Check the continuity
of the receive (RXD) and transfer (TXD) wires.
Check continuity between:
X1-5 main board and X1-3 console
X1-6 main board and X1-4 console
NO
correct?
YES
NEXT PAGE
29.42
PREVIOUS PAGE
Check if additional ground like between main
board terminal X9 and central unit box mounting
bracket is in place.
Install ground link - single cable minimum of
AWG14 (2.0mm2) between terminal X9/2 and
central unit box mounting bracket.
NO
correct?
YES
Ensure that cable shields are connected correctly.
Refer to connections and wiring diagrams.
NO
correct?
YES
Find out which component of the crane electric
is spiking out (e.g. dump valve, outrigger relay).
Install a diode or varistor across terminals of
spiking component. Diode type such as 1N 4001
can be used (watch + and - connection for diode).
END
29.43
INTERFERENCE PROBLEM
PROBLEM
Interference from crane electric.
Error Code E93 / E94 intermittent.
Frozen console displays.
START
Check system out; - Bad Data
Transfer Between Console & Central Unit.
NO
correct?
YES
Check if additional ground like between main
board terminal X9 and central unit box mounting
bracket is in place.
Install ground link - single cable minimum of
AWG14 (2.0mm2) between terminal X9/1 and
central unit box mounting bracket.
NO
correct?
YES
Ensure that cable shields are connected correctly.
Refer to connections and wiring diagrams.
NO
correct?
YES
Find out which component of the crane electric
is spiking out (e.g. dump valve, outrigger relay).
Install a diode or varistor across terminals of
spiking component. Diode type such as 1N 4001
can be used (watch + and - connection for diode).
Refer to Drawing 8, Suppressor Diode
END
29.44
PROBLEM
Error code displayed. Lever lockout activated.
Warning lights on.
ERROR
DISPLAY
ERROR
CAUSE
ACTION
E 01*
E 02*
E 03*
E 04*
E 05*
E 06*
29.45
ERROR
CAUSE
E 07
No acknowledgement signal
from overload relay (K8).
E 08
No acknowledgement signal
from Anti-Two-Block switch
relay (K9).
E 11
E 12
E 13
E 14
ACTION
Pressure transducer on
piston side defective.
Electronic component in
the measuring channel defective
on main board.
29.46
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 15
E 16
ERROR
Fallen below lower limiting
value for the measuring
channel "angle main boom".
CAUSE
ACTION
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
See page 35.58.
E 18
E 19
Electronic component on
the main board defective.
+5 volt supply
E 1A
E 1B
E 21
29.47
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 22
E 23
E 24
E 25
E 26
ERROR
Upper limiting value for the
measuring channel "pressure
piston side exceeded.
CAUSE
ACTION
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
29.48
ERROR
Upper limit value for the measurchannel 7 exceeded.
CAUSE
Cable from central unit to the
Sensor of channel 7 defective
or loose.
Sensor of channel 7 defective.
Electronic component in the
measuring channel 7 defective.
E 29
E 2A
E 2B
E 31
E 37
ACTION
Check cable.
Replace if necessary.
Replace angle sensor and reset
mechanical adjustment.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
E 38
E 39
E 41
E 42
Internal defect in
digital part of CPU.
29.49
ERROR
CAUSE
E 42
E 43
E 45
Error in internal
communications.
Error in A/D
conversion
Malfunction in the
monitored write/read
memory.
Defective electronic
component.
Defective electronic
component.
Internal defect in
in digital part of CPU
E 46
E 47
ACTION
Exchange write/read memory
(CMOS-RAM). Replace main
Board and reset pressure
channels.
Exchange write/read memory
(CMOS-RAM). Replace main
Board and reset pressure
channels.
Replace main board and
reset pressure channels.
Replace main board and
reset pressure channels.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
E 48
E 51
E 52
E 71
Replace K9 relay.
E 72 E 77
E 89
29.50
ERROR
No data transmission from
console to central unit.
(See page 35.42)
CAUSE
24V supply of console
interrupted.
Interruption or accidental
ground in the line from
console electronics to
central unit.
E 92
E 93
Interruption or accidental
ground in the data line from
central unit to console.
E 94
ACTION
Electromagnetic interferences
(e.g. when switching
contactors or valves).
29.51
ERROR
DISPLAY
E 95
ERROR
Error in the crane data EPROM
CAUSE
Data EPROM defective.
Position of jumper for the selection
of the type of EPROM is wrong.
Electronic component on main board
defective.
ACTION
Replace data EPROM.
Check the jumper position.
Replace main board and reset
pressure channels.
E 96
E 97
E 98
29.52
X2 : RED
X1 : BROWN
29.53
G1
MP42
KGND
MP 26
KGND
GND
MP 9
+6V
X15
GND
MP 4
+5V
MP 8
AGND
KGND
+BATT
MP24
MP23
VBAT
+UB1
PWM DC
+9V
GND
5
+UB1 +UB
DI 6
KGND
X12
MP40
V10 H11 V11MP41
H1 H2 H3 H4 H5 H6
DI 1
MP21
PFAIL+UB1
DI 1- DI 6 =>
X17
power o.k.
X14
J11
X11
SP5
X13
TXD
H12
AGND
H10
K8
MP29
10
LEVER
LOCKOUT
K10
A2B
+UB
2
1
MAIN
ON/OFF
KGND
J10
3
4
LMI
KGND
10
LOAD
+5V/RS232
AGND
K9
F
1
H9
A2B
69 68
67 66 65 64
63 62
61 60 59 58
57 56
55 54
12
KGND
3
1
77 76
KGND
KGND
J4
J3
J2
J1
X1
12
11
KGND
F
2
11
X1
13
X16
KGND
MP1
+UBS
36 35 34
33
32 31
30 29 28 27 26
25 24 23
22 21 20
19 18 17
16 15 14
13 12 11
LOCATIONS :
MP 1 - zone M13 = GND.
MP 25 - zone M13 = +UBS
MP 8 - zone M2 = +9V
MP 9 - zone M2 = +6V
MP 4 - zone M1 = +5V
MP 26 - zone M1 = GND.
MP 23 - zone A2 = VBATT
MP 24 - zone D2 = +BATT
MP 40 - zone M4 = +UB
29.54
10 9
MP 25
13
MP7
J1
J13
J12
J2
D3
D1
MP4
D2
X1
D14
X2
D13
P1
SYSTEM
D10
J8
D6
J9 MP3 J6
D17
J10
D15
D7
D21
D9
D12
J15
J11
J14
D18
J7
D11
D19
D20
X3
BR6
MP6MP5
EJECT
BR5
MP2
A102 CPU
J1
J2
DATA
D1
J5
J3
TLK
D3
J6
BR
4
3
2
1
X1
A103 DATEN
29.55
P7
MP12
1
2
40
AGND
AGND
-
P6
MP13
J2
20
P5
16
P4
P3
MP9
J1
MP11
X16
P2
MP10
P1
1 1
2
X1
MP17
BR1
MP0
MP8
VREFA
P8
MP7 - MP1->
X17
1
2
MP16
16
6 5
4 3
MP14
2 1
40
1
2
AGND
29.56
AGND
MP 2
+7V
MP 5
+5V
MP 0
GND
MP 3
-24V
MP 4
-24V
MP 6
MP 7
MP 1
+UB
J2
J5
J1
J4
J3
X1
X5 1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
29.57
PAT
PAT
XA2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
S
X2
1 X3
1
2
3
3
5
L
XB2
X2
1 X4
1
2
3
3
5
A
X2
X1
7 (9)
8 (10)
9333103309
29.58
COMPONENT
CAUSING
INTERFERENCE
+
SUPPRESSOR DIODE
29.59
IN
FUSE ( 10A)
OUT
L/O
OVERRIDE
FUSE ( 4A )
NORMAL
OPERATION
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 30
9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 10
4 1 2 3
1 2 3
A B C
A B C
A B CD E F
TO MAIN BOOM
CONNECTOR
NC
crane 12 o area
definition switch
in ele. swivel
CRANE SYSTEM AREA
DEF. SWITCH
ELEC. SWIVEL
GN/YL
+UBS
LMI BYPASS
FUSE (4 amp)
59 60
61 62
10 AMP
FUSE
LMI BYPASS
KEY SWITCH
7 PIN PLUG
+UBE
SIG+
SIGGND
+UB
GND
TXD
RXD
A2B
A2B
LOAD
D1
1 2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
A B C
A B C
V V V
V V V V
1 2 3 4
V V V
NO
C
1 2 3 4
A BC D
V V V V
1 2 3 4
V V V
A BCD E
A BCD E
V V V
X7 1 2 3 4
X8
+UBE 1
GND 2
V V VV V V
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 X1
5 PIN
DEUTSCH
1 2 3 4 PLUG
V V VV V
71K (+UB)
51AJ (GND)
10 8 9
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
V VVV V
V V V V
V V V V
30.1
V
V
4 5
NOT USED
4 AMP
FUSE
CONSOLE (1318)
1 2 3
FUSE (4 amp)
NOT USED
NOT USED
NOT USED
A2B GROUND
A2B SIGNAL
FORCE
ANGLE
GND
LENGTH
+UB
ROD
GND
+UB
GND
PISTON
1 2 3
+UB
DI4
DI2+24V=O/F - RUB.
DI1
GND
+UBS
1
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 53 54
OUT
23 24 25
IN
5 6
20 21 22
OUT
3 4
14 15 16 17 19
IN
1 2
51 52 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
GN/YL
1 2 11 12 13 18
GND
+UB
GND
RXD
TXD
A2B BYPASS
A2B BYPASS
LMI BYPASS
+UB
+UB
DI 3 (+24V HOUSE
PIN ENGAGED)
+UB
GND
K10 (COM) +24V
X1
NOTES:
pres. trans.
(piston)
pres. trans.
(rod)
LIGHTBAR
DS350
GRAPHIC MODULAR B.C.S.
CENTRAL UNIT
7 PIN PLUG
RT865BXL (BCS)
DS350 Graphic Modular
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
30.2
LENGTH
ANGLE
TRANSDUCER TRANSDUCER
RED
X2
12345678
BRN
X1
X4
+ 24V
SIG.
GND
X3
+ 24V
SIG.
GND
5 6
123 4
CORE
SHEILD
SHEILD
CORE
3=RED
2=BRN
1=BLK
3
2
1
1234
12
VV
A B
A B
V V
4.7K
4.7K
1
15
16
17
18
13
10 11 12 14 3
S/S HARNESS
23 - SOCKET RECEPT
238A
1083
255A
257A
323A
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
2
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
5
IM TELE
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
O
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
4
CM TELE
OM / FLY TELE
387A
388
239B
242B
243B
244B
71H
51AK
GND
30.3
+ 24V
1
11
16
V V V V V V V V V V VV VV VVV V V
V V V V V VVVVVVV V V
X1 26 28 29 31 33 30 32 34 36 38 40 42 4 5 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
25
13
17
4 3 2 1
18
8
13 14
7 10
12 14
RT865BXL (BCS)
BUS EXTENSION
WIRING DIAGRAM
1 4
A B C DE FG H J
GND
64 63
27
1
2
A104
X1
PV EXTENSION
K L
3 5 9 10
6
7
1
1
2
2
M N P
DI 6 ( +24V = IM RET )
DI 7 ( +24V = IM % RESET )
K7 COM ( +24V )
K6 NC
K6 COM ( + 24V )
K5 NC ( PROP RET )
K5 NO ( PROP EXT )
K5 COM
K4 NO
K4 COM
K2 COM ( +24V )
K2 NO ( +24V TO IM 2-WAY SOLS. )
K3 COM ( +24V )
K3 NO ( +24V TELE ROD DRAIN SOL. )
K3 NC
DI 7 GND
DI 6 GND
DI 5 GND
DI 4 GND
DI 3 GND
DI 2 GND
DI 1 GND
GND
+ 24V
+24V
K7 NC
A
101
41 39 37 35
12
13
3 5 8 9 11
7 15
= WIRES ARE
GROUPED
TOGETHER
14 - SOCKET PLUG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
19 - SOCKET PLUG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
NOTES:
1
OUTER SHIELD GROUNDED AT STRAIN
RELIEF CONNECTOR.
2
INNER SHIELD CUT AND INSULATED
14 - SOCKET PLUG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
V V V V V VVVVVVV V V
V V V V V VVVVVVV V V
RT865BXL (BCS)
19 - SOCKET PLUG
A B C DE FG H J
A B C DE FG H J
A B C DE FG H J
A B C DE FG H J
13 14
11
13 14
X2
135
18 19
4 5 6 7
8 9
10
1 2 3
86
11 12
9 14 12
13 14
5 10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 S 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
135
7 8 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
13
18 19
AGND
SIG.
-5V
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BLK
SHD
BLK
WHT/BLK
GRA
VIO
WHT
BRN
GRN
CRE
BLK
RED
PNK
YEL
BLU
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
GRA
VIO
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
WHT
BRN
GRN
CRE
BLK
RED
PNK
YEL
BLU
10 11
WHT/
BLK
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
LENGTH
TRANS.
WHT/
BLK
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
BLK
BLK
WHT/BLK
10 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
LENGTH
TRANS.
BRN
RED
ORG
YEL
GRN
BLU
VIO
GRA
WHT
30.4
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 S 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
7 8 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
1 2
X2
9 10
11 12
K L M N P R S T U V
K L M N P R S T U V
X1
10
X1
6 7 12
8 9
X3
1 2 3
4 5 6 7
AGND
SIG.
-5V
4
2
3
1
K L M N P
K L M N P
X3
1 2
SHD
VIO
YEL
PNK
RED
BLK
GRA
BLU
CRE
SHD
WHT
BRN
GRN
JUNCTION
BOX (CM)
1 RED 1
RED
2
BLK
1
3
BLK
4
5 GRN 1
GRN
6
WHT
1
7
WHT
8
BLU
9
BLK
10
BRN
11
WHT
TIE WRAP
USED TO IDENTIFY CABLE
PROXY SW 3 (TOP)
(IM % RESET)
BRN
1 (+)
BLK
4 NO
WHT
2 NC
BLU
3 (-)
IS
PROXY SW 1
(OM/FLY RETR)
BRN
1 (+)
BLK
WHT
IS
BLU
4 NO
2 NC
(-)
IS
30.5
RED
YEL
BLU
VIO
GRA
BLK
CRE
PNK
JUNCTION
BOX (IM)
1
2
3
4
SHD
WHT
BRN
GRN
5
6
7
RED
BLK
GRN
WHT
BLU
BLK
BRN
BRN
BLK
WHT
WHT
IS
BLU
IS
1 (+)
4 NO
2 NC
(-)
4
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
PROXY SW 2 (BOTTOM)
(IM RETR. 2-POSITIONS)
BRN
1 (+)
BLK
O
4 NO
WHT
O
2 NC
BLU
3 (-)
IS
BLU WHT
BLU
BLK
BLK
BRN
BRN
WHT
JUNCTION BOX
BOOM BASE
RT865BXL (BCS)
DS350 Graphic Modular
Wiring to Proximity Switches
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 31
ERROR-E80-E85-E2D
E80 - Slewing pot out of range.
E85 - This code has only been seen on the Modular Boom Control System. The error pertains to the
internal calculation of radius ( not the displayed radius ). The displayed radius is calculated from
the boom length and signals received from the upper cable reel to the C.U. in the cab. The other
two length signals as well as all proximity switches inputs are received by the bus extension located
on the left turntable upright behind the cab. The bus extension has its own processor which
performs calculations and transmits data to the processor in the C.U.
1. Negative load display due to the velocity fuse in the piston side transducer port of the
lift cylinder.
A. The system sees a - 3,000 lb. load display and thinks that the boom must be
deflecting backward. This confuses the processor when performing its
internal calculation of radius.
2. Water in cannon connections located under the base boom. There are two fourteen
conductor and one seven conductor cables running to the cable reels on the left side of
the base boom section.
A. Found water in these connectors which caused length and percentage
problems.
B. Found twisted wires, pinched wires and in general poor assembly from PAT.
Some symptoms of water add poor assembly are that the bus extension may
receive low voltage such as +2 volt input for a proximity switch .when the
boom is extended. At this time you should see 0 volts and of course when any
of the proximity switches see their target you should see 24 volt to the input.
When the bus extension processor sees any voltage from these inputs when
the sections are extended, the processor gets confused and shows E85. Also
the lower two reels length signals may check okay at the reel, but through
these connectors the signal changes until the signal reaches the bus extension.
3. On other cause that was found for the E85 is a bad eprom module. There is a small serial
eprom ( located in the C.U. ) which contains some calibration factors which are used for
calibration purposes. Sometimes this serial eprom loses its memory and causes the E85. In
this case you must replace the eprom module. The Grove part number is 9-333-103289.
E2D - This is an error in the processor board located inside the bus extension box located behind
the cab (top left board ) At this time there is no troubleshooting procedure for this board. The
board must be replaced to correct this error. The Grove part number is 9-333-103718.
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 32
iFLEX5
SERVICE INFORMATION
GENERAL INFORMATION
This service manual is designed to assist a service or maintenance person in identifying system
problem areas or malfunctions. A digital voltmeter with the capability to measure current will be
required, along with standard maintenance and service tools. NOTE: Knowledge of how to use a
voltmeter to measure both voltage and current is assumed.
REFERENCE:
For system operation, refer to the consoles operators manual 9333103876.
WARNINGS
The LMI is an operational aid that warns a crane operator of approaching overload conditions and
over hoist conditions that could cause damage to equipment and personnel.
The device is not, and shall not be, a substitute for good operator judgment, experience and use of
accepted safe crane operating procedures.
The responsibility for the safe crane operation shall remain with the crane operator who shall ensure
that all warnings and instructions supplied are fully understood and observed.
Prior to operating the crane, the operator must carefully and thoroughly read and understand the
information in this manual to ensure that he knows the operation and limitations of indicator and crane.
Proper functioning depends upon proper daily inspection and observance of the operating instructions
set forth in this manual. Refer to Section 6. Pre-Operation Inspection and Calibration Verification of the
operators manual.
The LMI can only work correctly, if all adjustments have been properly set. For correct
adjustment, the operator has to answer thoroughly and correctly all questions asked during
the setup procedure in accordance with the real rigging state of the crane. To prevent
material damage and serious or even fatal accidents, the correct adjustment of the LMI has
to be ensured before starting the crane operation.
iFLEX 5
32-1
The PAT Load Moment Indicator system operates on the principle of reference/real comparison. The
real value, resulting from the pressure measurement is compared with the reference data, stored in
the central processor memory and evaluated in the microprocessor. When limits are reached, an
overload warning signal is generated at the operators console. At the same time, the aggravating
crane movements, such as hoist up, telescope out and boom down, will be stopped.
The fixed data regarding the crane, such as capacity charts, boom weights, centers of gravity and
dimensions are stored in memory chips in the central processor unit. This data is the reference
information used to calculate the operating conditions.
Boom length and boom angle are registered by the length/angle sensor, mounted inside the cable
reel, which is mounted on the boom. The boom length is measured by the cable reel cable, which also
serves as an electrical conductor for the anti two-block switches.
The crane load is measured by pressure transducer block attached to the piston and rod side of the
hoist cylinders.
The interactive user guidance considerably simplifies the input of operating modes as well as the
setting of geometry limit values.
iFLEX 5
32-2
A pressure transducer block houses two transducers, CAN bus controller, and two bus connectors.
One pressure transducer is connected to the piston side of the lift cylinder and the other to the rod
side.
The Length-Angle Transducer: The length-angle sensor (LWG), often referred to as the cable reel,
is a combination of two transducers in one box, installed at the base section of the boom. It measures
the length and the angle of the boom.
A reeling drum drives a potentiometer, which is the length transducer. Part of the length transducer
circuit is the length cable on the drum, which is a two-conductor cable (screen and live). It is
connected to the anti-two-block switch at the boom head and to a slip ring body in the LWG.
The angle transducer is a potentiometer driven by a weighted pendulum that is oil damped. Both
length and angle transducer are connected to a CAN bus controller board, which is connected to the
bus.
Anti-Two-Block Switch: The anti-two-block switch monitors the load block and its relationship with
the head of the boom. In working condition the switch is closed. When the hook block strikes the
weight the circuit opens, disengaging a relay output to the lock out solenoid valves, where applicable.
To check the cable for damage, (short circuit to ground) there is a 4.7k resistor between ground and
the contact of the switch, to give a signal back to the central unit. The weight at the anti-two-block
switch keeps the switch closed until the hook block strikes it.
Console: The graphic console displays all geometrical information such as length and angle of main
boom, working radius and head height of the boom. It also displays the actual load and the maximum
load permitted by load chart. Furthermore, it has an alarm horn, a warning light for overload, and a
pre-warning light. The graphic display allows for a simple interactive configuration setup, as well as
sensor calibration (zero adjustment), and troubleshooting sensor output screen. The console has a
warning light for anti-two-block conditions and an override switch for overload or anti-block condition.
Central Unit: Inside the central unit there is a CPU and connection board. The board has a hard
mounted connector for power, ground, bus controller, and slew indication. The board has a green
LED, indicating relay energized and a communication LED that flashes through red, yellow, and green
colors.
iFLEX 5
32-3
WHATS WRONG?
So, whats wrong? Assuming you are reading these pages because of some kind of problem with the
PAT system, let us try to guide you quickly to solving the problem. In most cases, your problem will fall
under the following categories:
THE DISPLAYED ANGLE DOES NOT MATCH THE ACTUAL BOOM ANGLE
Start in section Angle Sensing to check the indicated angle.
THE DISPLAYED LENGTH DOES NOT MATCH THE ACTUAL BOOM LENGTH
Start in section Length Sensing to check the indicated length.
THE DISPLAYED SLEWING DOES NOT MATCH THE ACTUAL SLEWING ANGLE
Refer to section Slewing Sensing to check the slew sensor.
iFLEX 5
32-4
ANGLE SENSING
The System measures the angle of the main boom of the machine with an angle sensor. The angle
sensor is contained within the cable reel, located on the left side of the main boom.
Block Diagram
Angle
Sensor
CAN-Bus
Converter
iFLEX5
CU
Pressure Transducer
Cable Reel
The signal runs from the angle sensor to the Can-Bus converter board, both located in the cable reel.
From there, it travels as digital information on the CAN-Bus to the pressure transducer, which acts as
a T-connector to the main CAN-Bus running to the central unit.
So, what do you do when you are having a problem with your angle read-out?
Start by verifying the angle display. Refer to the section Troubleshooting A Sensor Problem Using
The Display to call up the sensor signal on your console display. The CAN-Bus is digital and as such
will either transmit the signal correctly or not at all. If your readings are off, you have to determine what
is causing the problem. Start by opening the cable reel and locate the angle sensor (right) and the
CAN-Bus converter board (left):
iFLEX 5
32-5
X14 (A2B)
X20 (length)
X21 (angle)
LED
X1 (CAN)
iFLEX 5
32-6
The angle sensor returns a voltage between 1.875V at 90 degrees and 3.125V at 0 degrees:
Angle Sensor Signal on
Pin 2
Angle
Voltage
90
1.875
75
2.083
60
2.292
45
2.500
30
2.708
15
2.917
0
3.125
Note: Actual voltages will vary slightly.
Measure this voltage between Pin 1 (GND) and Pin 2 of Terminal X21.
If you need to determine the angle for voltages other than the above, do so by using the following
formula:
Angle (degrees) = 90 degrees ((Voltage-1.875) * 72)
If this angle matches your actual angle, but the indicated angle varies significantly (more than 0.4
degrees), the angle sensor is fine and the error is somewhere else. If this angle varies significantly
from your actual angle, the angle sensor is bad and needs to be exchanged. Otherwise, continue:
At this point, you have verified that the angle sensor is giving you the right output to match your actual
angle, but the system is displaying the wrong angle. If you can rule out software and operator error, it
is most likely that the converter board is defective and it needs to be exchanged.
iFLEX 5
32-7
LENGTH SENSING
The system measures the length of the main boom of the machine with a length sensor. The length
sensor is contained within the cable reel, located on the left side of the main boom.
Block Diagram
Length
Sensor
CAN-Bus
Converter
iFLEX5
CU
The
signal
runs
Pressure
Transducer
from
the
length
sensor
Cable Reel
to the CAN-Bus
converter board, both located in
the cable reel. From there, it travels as digital information on the CAN-Bus to the pressure transducer,
which acts as a T-connector to the main CAN-Bus running to the central unit.
So, what do you do when you are having a problem with your length read-out?
Start by verifying the length display. Refer to the section Troubleshooting A Sensor Problem Using
The Display to call up the sensor signal on your console display. The CAN-Bus is digital and as such
will either transmit the signal correctly or not at all. If your readings are off, you have to determine what
is causing the problem. Start by checking the length cable tension, the cable reel has 5-8 turns of preloading on the reel. Opening the cable reel and locate the length sensor (right) and the CAN-Bus
converter board (left):
iFLEX 5
32-8
Fully retract the boom and turn the screw of the length potentiometer with a small screwdriver counter
clockwise to a soft stop. That should bring the sensor voltage to 0V (+/- 0.1Volt).
Measure voltage between Pin 5 (-) and Pin 3 of Terminal X20 and compare.
Potentiometer
Go back to your indication screen and compare length indicated and actual again. If the indicated
length varies significantly from your actual length (more than 0.3 feet), the length sensor might be bad
and needs to be exchanged. Note, however, that the error could also be in the software or in the
converter board.
X14 (A2B)
X20 (length)
X21
LED
X1 (CAN)
iFLEX 5
32-9
The length sensor has a potentiometer built in that is driven by a gear drive from the cable drum. As
the length changes, the cable drum will turn and with it the potentiometers axle. The converter board
supplies a voltage of about 4.7V to the length potentiometer and in return monitors the output voltage
of the potentiometer. The terminal used is X20. The length sensor is connected as follows:
Terminal X20
1
+ (~ 4.8V)
3
Signal
5
- (~ 0.2V)
Verify that the sensor is being supplied with about 4.7V by measuring between pin 5 (-) and Pin 1 (+)
of terminal X20. If the voltage is outside of a range of 4.5 to 5 V, the converter board might be
defective. Unplug length sensor and measure again. If the voltage is still off, exchange converter
board. If unplugging the length sensor made the voltage return into the acceptable range, exchange
length sensor. If the voltage is correct continue:
The length sensor returns a voltage between 0.16V at 0 turns of the length pot (= fully retracted) and
4.84V at 10 turns. How many turns you get at full extension depends on the gear ratio, the boom
length, the length cable used and the spooling pattern, so we cannot provide a standard table for it.
What we can give you for trouble-shooting, however is the following table that shows the expected
output voltage (measured between X20-5 and X20-3 Signal) for each complete turn of the length
potentiometer. Note that this does not sync to the number of turns of the cable reel, though:
Length Sensor Signal on Pin 3
Turns
Voltage X20-5 to
X20-3
0
0.00
1
0.46
2
0.93
3
1.40
4
1.87
5
2.34
6
2.81
7
3.28
8
3.75
9
4.22
10
4.68
For the boom control system, the length sensors are the same as described above with the exception
of cable reel internals (location of hardware, wiring, and gear wheels). Refer to the LWG520 and
LG152 spare part list for these differences.
iFLEX 5
32-10
PRESSURE SENSING
The System measures the pressure of the boom lift cylinder for both rod- and piston-side. Both
sensors are contained within one box that also contains the electronics needed for amplification and
creation of the CAN-Bus signal.
Block Diagram:
(2)
PressureMeasuring
Cells
Pressure Transducer
CAN-Bus
Converter
iFLEX5
CU
So, what do you do when you are having a problem with your length read-out?
Start by checking the pressure display. Refer to the section Troubleshooting A Sensor Problem Using
The Display to call up the sensor signal on your console display.
The easiest spot to check the signal at is when there is no pressure applied to the sensor at all. The
only time this is for certain is when your pressure lines are drained and disconnected. In that case, the
readout should show about 500mV (+/- 25mV) and 0 PSI. Small variations could be adjusted; see
section Service Screen For Sensor Calibration.
The CAN-Bus is digital and as such will either transmit the signal correctly or not at all. If your readings
are off, chances are the pressure transducer is defective. Replace.
Note: After exchanging the pressure transducer block, BOTH transducer channels need to be zeroed,
see procedure Zero-Setting The Transducer Inputs.
iFLEX 5
32-11
SLEWING SENSING
The system measures the slewing (rotational position) of the cranes upper with a slewing sensor. The
slewing sensor is contained within the slip ring assembly.
Block Diagram
Slew
Potentiomet
er with (2)
outputs
Current
Converter
iFLEX5
CU
ANGLE
(deg)
0
30.3
60
89.9
120.1
150.1
180
-150.1
-120.1
-90
-60.1
-30
0
SL ANG 1
(mv)
717
1174
1680
2158
2641
3144
3595
3144
2642
2160
1681
1172
718
SL ANG 2
(mv)
2161
2645
3150
3595
3141
2639
2161
1681
1180
718
1168
1680
2161
4000
MILLIVOLTS
3500
3000
2500
2000
1500
Potentiometer 1
1000
Potentiometer 2
500
0
0
Display screen 0
for sensor inputs
45
45
90
90
135
135
180
225
180
-135
SLEW ANGLE
iFLEX 5
270
-90
315
-45
360
0
32-12
The converter board is supplied with 12V from the central unit. The potentiometer and the board output
two signals between 4 and 20mA that go to the central unit. You can measure them at the 12-pin crane
interface connector. Start by making sure that the slew pot unit is supplied with crane voltage. Pin 7
must carry crane voltage and pin 2 is GND. The slew units output can be found on pins 8 and 9. In
order to measure the current, however, you have to disconnect a pin and measure in line with it
(measuring meter in between the cable from the slew unit and the central unit). The two outputs will
vary as shown in this chart:
Modular Slew Pot - Output Currents
mA 2
mA 3
24
20
mA
16
12
8
4
0
0
90
180
270
360
Degrees
(when the crane is over front, you should see about 4mA in one channel (wire #2) and 12mA in the
other channel (wire #3)).
Alternatively, you can also leave the wires connected and use your meter in Voltage-mode to measure
the output signals. In that case, you will see the 420mA signal range as a 1.1 to 5.5Volt range. In that
case, refer to the following chart:
If the voltage or currents do not fall in line with the charts and tables shown here, and no system errors
are present, the problem may be a mechanical. Open the slip ring unit and find out if the slew
potentiometer is set correctly.
LOAD SENSING
Please note that the load displayed by the LMI is not a direct measurement, but a calculated value that
is based on a lot of factors. Outside of the measured values (sensors), those include:
iFLEX 5
32-13
NO CONSOLE DISPLAY
If the console is not showing any lights, such as warning lights, backlighting, etc. it is most likely
missing power. Start with the following:
Next, check if power is being supplied by the central unit. Measure on the green connector. Pin 1 is
+Ub (12V), Pin 2 is GND. If you have no power, check wiring harness and central unit. Otherwise,
open console:
Check fuses in console: one (F6) is located the connection board (mounted to the inside of the
housing) which protects the override key switch function and the bargraph. The main fuse (F1) is
located on the console processor board. If both fuses are fine, check for power on connector X6 on
the connection board (Pin 1 = +Ub, Pin 2 = GND). If you have no power there (but you had power on
the external connector), most likely the connection board is defective and needs to be replaced. If you
have power on this connector, follow it to the console computer board, connector X1. Again, Pin 1 =
+Ub and Pin 2 = GND. If you have no power there, the connecting cable must be defective or loose. If
you still have power there, check fuse F1 again.
Next, make sure all connectors are correctly in place:
Connection board
Computer board
Pins
X6
X1
4
X10
X22
6
X7
X2
10
Especially verify that the X10-X22 connection is right, since it could be plugged into X17 by mistake
Check TxD LED is on. This LED is located in the center of the computer board and is normally blinking
when the console is communicating.
If you find voltage on all pins outlined and all connectors are in place, but you still do not get any light
to come up (during power-up especially!), either the software is defective or the console electronic
needs to be replaced.
iFLEX 5
32-14
A2B PROBLEM
First, perform the following operations:
Are the control levers locked out and is the crane in an anti-two block condition?
YES, Lower the hook block and/or headache ball to correct two-block condition. If two (2)
hoists are in use, both hooks must be lowered.
Is the anti-two block warning light on? Check Bypass plug installed, if not plug appropriate bypass plug
into socket of junction box.
Is the Bypass plug installed and the anti-two block warning light on?
Turn power off, remove the bypass plug, and measure the resistance at the boom nose box between
terminals 1 and 3 with an ohmmeter. This checks the function of the Anti-Two Block switch. Switch
closed = 0Ohms (weight installed); Switch open => 1 Megaohm (weight removed) Ohmmeter reading
are correct?
YES, Plug the bypass plug into the boom nose box and refer to system wiring to check wire
connections in boom nose box. If wiring is correct, replace Anti-Two-Block switch.
Ensure the bypass plug is plugged into the boom nose box. Measure the A2B signal in the cable reel
between X1:Brown and X2:Red wires on the slip ring with an ohmmeter. Switch closed =4700
500Ohms; Switch open => 1 Megaohm. Ohmmeter readings are correct?
NO, Check for damaged length cable and wiring. If broken length cable, refer to system wiring.
Measure the A2B signal in the cable reel between terminal 7 and 8 with an ohmmeter. Switch closed
=4700 500Ohms; Switch open => 1 Megaohm. Ohmmeter readings are correct?
NO, Replace slip ring
Problem with wiring harness, cable reel length/angle board, and/or central unit.
iFLEX 5
32-15
CAN-BUS COMMUNICATION
The System measures the length of the main boom, the angle of the main boom, the pressures of the
lift cylinder, and the A2B state of the machine via a CAN-Bus connection. Since this is a digital bus
connection, it is not possible to measure the signals on the bus with a multimeter. Instead, the LMI
provides you with error codes that give you an indication of the bus state.
The error codes are one of the following:
E61
E62
E63
E64
E65
Error in the CAN bus data transfer for all CAN units
Error in the can bus data transfer of the pressure transducer sensor unit
Error in the can bus pressure transducer sensor unit
Error in the can bus data transfer of the length/angle sensor unit
Error in the can bus length/angle sensor unit
Block Diagram
E65
CAN-Bus
Converter
E64
E61
iFLEX5
CU
E62
Pressure Transducer
Cable Reel
E63
The block diagram tries to clarify that: If the CU does not see any CAN-Bus component, it will report
an E61. If it sees only the cable reel, it will report an E62 (pressure transducer missing). If it sees only
the pressure transducer, it will report an E64 (cable reel missing). E63 means that the pressure
transducer is available, but is reporting an internal error. E65 means that the cable reel unit is
available, but is reporting an internal error.
So, what do you do when you are having a problem with one of those codes?
E61
In case of an E61, start by checking your cabling. You can verify that power is being supplied to the
sensor by testing the CAN connectors per this layout:
Connector
M12, 5 contacts
Pin 1
Pin 2
Pin 3
Pin 4
Pin 5
Shield
+ Ub
Ground
CAN High
CAN Low
Measure between pins 3 and 2 for crane voltage. If you see voltage, check all pins for continuity.
Remember, the CU is reporting that neither cable reel nor pressure transducers are present.
iFLEX 5
32-16
E62
In case of an E62 the CU is reporting no signal from the pressure transducer. Start by checking your
cabling between CU and pressure transducer, even though it is not very likely that there is a problem
with it since the same cable carries also the signals from the cable reel and those appear to be fine.
You can verify that power is being supplied to the sensor by testing the CAN connectors per the above
pin layout. If you are sure that the sensor is being supplied, you have to replace the pressure
transducer.
E63
In case of an E63, the pressure transducer is reporting an internal problem. You cannot troubleshoot
any further, but need to replace the pressure transducer.
E64
In case of an E64, the CU is reporting no signal from the cable reel unit. Start by checking your cabling
between pressure transducer and cable reel. You can verify that power is being supplied to the sensor
by testing the CAN connectors per the above pin layout or by opening up the cable reel (remove the
lid) and making sure the red LED on the board is blinking.
X14 (A2B)
X20
X21
LE
X1 (CAN)
iFLEX 5
32-17
X1 Pin
CAN
CAN_SHLD1
CAN +UB
CAN GND
CAN_H
CAN_L
Measure between pins 3 (GND) and 2 (+). Next, check all pins of the CAN bus cable for continuity and
cross-check for short circuits. E-64 means that the pressure transducer is working fine, but the cable
reel is not so we most likely have a defective connection between those two components. If this is
tested to not be the case (missing connections, short circuits measure with Ohm-meter), the board in
the cable reel might be defective (see also chapter Angle Sensing).
E65
In case of an E65, the cable reel is reporting an internal problem. In most cases, this will be an angle
sensor, length potentiometer or A2B wiring. Go to those chapters (Angle Sensing, Length Sensing,
A2B PROBLEM) to continue trouble shooting.
iFLEX 5
32-18
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 33
TROUBLESHOOTING
a SENSOR PROBLEM USING
the DISPLAY
10
10
.
10
.
10
.
The screen will show all sensor inputs as in the example below. For each sensor, an equivalent
voltage is shown in millivolts, along with the physical sensor value that that voltage refers to.
Pressure sensors are shown with physical values of [bar], angle sensors and slew sensors in degrees
and length sensors in feet (or meter for metric charts). At the bottom of the screen, the console
software version is shown.
Press INFO
To review
software
version
information
10
The values shown in the screen here are just examples of actual values. Refer to the table listed
below for actual value ranges.
If you suspect a sensor error or problem with a sensor, compare the indicated physical value of the
sensor on the display screen with the real value, i.e. length, angle, etc.
iFLEX 5
33-1
The voltages given are internal calculation values only; you will not be able to actually measure them
anywhere on the electronics! Typical values to be expected are:
Pressure transducers (piston and rod), 500mV @ 0 PSI; 4500mV @ maximum PSI
Length sensor, 500mV @ retracted boom length; voltage extended depends on the various
boom lengths.
Angle sensor, 4500mV at 0; 2500mV at 45; or 500mV at 90
Pressure Transducers
300 bar, type 314
500
1500
2500
3500
4500
Angle Sensor
500
1500
2500
3500
4500
Length Sensor
500
1500
2500
3500
4500
PSI
0
1088
2176
3263
4351
Bar
0
75
150
225
300
degrees
90
67.5
45
22.5
0
boom horizontal
feet
0
fully retracted
boom vertical
If the displayed value does differ from the actual value, please refer to the following sections to find the
cause of the problem:
If the displayed angle is incorrect, please go to section Angle Sensing.
If the displayed length is incorrect, please go to section Length Sensing
If the displayed pressures are incorrect, please go to section Pressure Sensing
iFLEX 5
33-2
Sig 2 (mA)
0.03mA
12.00
16.00
20.00
16.00
12.00
8.00
4.00
8.00
iFLEX 5
33-3
DRAWINGS
COMPONENTS OF THE LMI SYSTEM PAT IFLEX5
PAT
POWER
LOCKOUT
OTHER
1 Central-Micro-Processor Unit
2 Operating Console
3 Pressure Transducers
4 Length/Angle Sensor
5 Anti Two-Block Switch(es)
iFLEX 5
33-4
BLOCK DIAGRAM
70 pin
Connector
RS 485
Serial
Interface
Crane Power
Graphic
Console
CANBUS
Current
4..20mA
CAN-connector
Slew Sensor
CAN-connector
CAN-connector
Dual Pressure
Length/Angle Sensor
iFLEX 5
A2B
33-5
iFLEX 5
33-6
iFLEX 5
33-7
iFLEX 5
33-8
1-1
iFLEX 5
33-9
TO LWG520/0002
REFER TO CABLE REEL
(LWG520/0002) WIRING DIAGRAM
iFLEX 5
33-10
iFLEX 5
33-11
TO LG152/0056
REFER TO CABLE REEL
(LG152/0056) WIRING DIAGRAM
iFLEX 5
33-12
iFLEX 5
33-13
QTY DESCRIPTION
1
CENTRAL UNIT ACCY, GROUNDING KIT
1
BATTERY, LITHIUM 3V
1
KEY SWITCH
1
CENTRAL UNIT COVER iFLEX
1
SCREW SET
1
SPARE KEY
42 GASKET
7
2
iFLEX 5
33-14
PART NO.
9333101691
9333103895
9333103892
1
1
1
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
9333103893
9333103894
9333103899
9333103900
9333103901
9333103902
9333103903
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
QTY DESCRIPTION
SPARE KEY, GRAPHIC CONSOLE
KEYSWITCH, WITH CABLE
FRONTFACE WITH DISPLAY, COMPUTER BOARDS, AND
LED BOARDS
CONNECTION BOARD WITH BUZZER
FUSE, 2 AMP AUTO
CABLE, 4 POL COMPUTER BRD X1 TO CONN BRD X6,X11
CABLE, 10 POL COMPUTER BRD X2 TO CONN BRD X7
CABLE, 6 POL COMPUTER BRD X10 TO CONN BRD X23
5 LED BOARD, LMI/A2B ALARM LITE
8 LED BOARD, LEDS BY SELECTION BUTTONS
4
9
3
3
6
7
1,2
10
iFLEX 5
33-15
4
5
1
7
iFLEX 5
33-16
8
4
3
iFLEX 5
33-17
9
7
5
10
1
iFLEX 5
33-18
9
6
13
7
5
iFLEX 5
33-19
iFLEX 5
33-20
iFLEX 5
33-21
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 34
SERVICE SCREEN
for SENSOR CALIBRATION
10
11
iFLEX 5
34-1
The return key toggles between the piston-side, the rod-side zero setting, and length, and angle
calibration.
When the sensor calibration is finished, pressing the ESC or INFO key returns the console display to
normal.
iFLEX 5
34-2
iFLEX 5
34-3
Now perform Length Sensor Adjustment Procedure as detailed in section Length Sensor Adjustment
Procedure.
iFLEX 5
34-4
iFLEX 5
34-5
13.
14.
15.
16.
iFLEX 5
34-6
iFLEX 5
34-7
Repeat the above procedure to verify/set the angle at 60 (range 55- 65). and 70 (range 65- 75).
boom angles.
Press ESC to leave service screen.
iFLEX 5
34-8
iFLEX 5
34-9
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 35
Boom Control
BCS
IM
CM
OM/Fly
DI
DO
PWM
0
1
The BCS controls the boom telescoping sequence by controlling the current supplied to the
proportional solenoids on the 4-way directional control valves. These valves provide oil to the
telescoping cylinders. Here are the basic components, inputs, outputs, and logical functions to
make this happen.
Components:
There are two modes of operation, manual or automatic mode. This is selectable by a switch in
the right hand arm rest in the cab, and is seen by the BCS as digital input 17. DI1 17=0 is manual
mode. And DI 17=1 is auto mode.
1
iFLEX 5
35-1
Primarily used for boom maintenance and function the boom in an unlikely event of a BCS failure.
In manual mode the boom is controlled by the section selector switch in the right hand arm rest in
the cab. When IM selected, crane electric provides full power to the extend and retract
proportional solenoids on the IM pilot operated 4-way directional control valve. This means the
telescoping action is controlled directly by moving the joystick or foot operated treadle valve. The
BCS does not control movement. Likewise when CM is selected, crane electric provides full
power to the extend and retract proportional solenoids on the CM pilot operated 4-way
directional control valve.
Note: In the event of an LMI error, overload, or A2B condition the proportional valves will be not
be energized unless the LMI bypass is activated, either from the central unit or console.
Auto Mode Operation:
An extend or retract action is initiated by moving the joystick or foot operated treadle valve
causing hydraulic pilot pressure to activate an extend or retract pressure switch. The pressure
switch signals are seen as digital inputs to the BCS. As an example of extend from fully
retracted, the BCS realizes DI 19=1 (extend pressure switch on) and simultaneously activates
DO2 8 (IM extend) and DO 3 (PWM 2, IM proportional solenoid). DO 8 energizes a relay in the
BCS relay junction box assy to direct DO 3 to the IM pilot operated 4-way directional control
extend proportional solenoid. Figure 1 illustrates how DO 3 is directed to the solenoid valve. DO
3 is a PWM output and ramps the output according to variables in the data software. Ramp-up
output is time based. When the IM section approaches a change over point (change in
sequence), DO 3 is ramped down according to variables in the data software. Ramp-down
output is percentage based. See table 1 and table 2 for sequencing information. At the
specified change over point, the BCS turns off DO 8 (IM extend) and simultaneously turns on DO
6 (CM extend) and DO 1 (PWM 1, CM proportional solenoid). DO 6 energizes a relay in the
BCS relay junction box assy to direct DO 1 to the CM pilot operated 4-way directional control
extend proportional solenoid. DO 1 is a PWM output and ramps the output according to
variables in the data software. When the CM section approaches a change over point DO 1
ouput is ramped down according to variables in the data software. And so on. When retracting,
the BCS realizes DO 18=1 (retract pressure switch) and does not activate DO 6 or DO 8. DO 1
or DO 3 are activated based on the current boom position.
figure 1
iFLEX 5
35-2
TELE SEQUENCE:
RT9000E: Mode A - not available
RT800E: Mode A
Mode B
table1
Mode "B" Extend Sequence in Percentage
Tele 1 (IM)
Tele 2 (CM)
Tele 3 (OM/Fly)
0
0
0
75
0
0
75
75
0
100
75
0
100
100
0
100
100
100
Digital
Input
6
7
8
9
10
11
16
17
18
19
Description
CM (Center-Mid) Retracted (boom proximity switch)
IM (Inner-Mid) Retracted (boom proximity switch)
Luffing Extension Raise (cab switch)
Luffing Extension Lower (cab switch)
Luffing Extension Raise (remote switch on ext.)
Luffing Extension Lower (remote switch on ext.)
A Mode (cab switch)
Auto Mode (cab switch)
Boom Retract (pressure switch)
Boom Extend (pressure switch)
iFLEX 5
*C.U. X2
Terminal
54
55
56
57
58
59
64
65
66
67
**MP
R89
R90
R91
R92
R93
R94
R100
R101
R102
R103
35-3
Description
PWM 1 CM Proportional Solenoid
+UB CAN bus
PWM 2 IM Proportional Solenoid
+UB to Slew Potentiometer Electronics
PWM 3 Luffing Extension Proportional Solenoid
CM Extend Relay K1 Coil in Junction Box
PWM 4 Luffing Extension Proportional Solenoid
IM Extend Relay K2 Coil in Junction Box
Luffing Extension Raise Solenoid
External LMI Alarm, Option on Boom
Luffing Extension Lower Solenoid
Rear Axle Oscillate Signal
Tele Rod Drain Solenoid
Boom Out of Sequence Lamp
Tele Two Stage Relief Solenoid
C.U. X2 Terminal
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
*C.U. =
Central Unit
**MP = Measuring Point; i.e. R89 designates resistor number; see sketches below for specific location; Notes:
must measure on bottom leg of the resistor.
DO 1 = PWM 1
DO 3 = PWM 2
DO 5 = PWM 3
DO 7 = PWM 4
iFLEX 5
35-4
A convenient method to monitor digital inputs (DI) and digital outputs (DO) is utilizing the iTOOL5
or iFLASH terminal function. At the flashing command prompt press and hold Ctrl and A to
enter the RTOS (an asterisk will display). Type digshow and press Enter. The result should be
the screen shown below. The inputs and outputs are counted from right to left and top to bottom
as illustrated below.
*digshow
T E S T
D E R
D I G I T A L - E I N U N D
A U S G A E N G E
=======================================================================
Baugr. | Port | Modus | IN-Wert | IN-Wert | OUT-Wert | OUT-Wert | Status
| :Taste |
| (Hex) |
(Bin) | (Hex)
| (Bin)
| =NoLoad
-------|--------|--------|---------|----------|----------|----------|-------Basis | 0 : 1 | NORMAL |
00
| 00000000 |
05
| 00000101 | 0000-1
Basis | 1 : 2 | NORMAL |
00
| 00000000 |
82
| 10000010 | 0011-0
Basis | 2 : 3 | NORMAL |
98
| 10011000 |
00
|
|
Erw. | 0 : 4 | NORMAL |
00
| 00000000 |
00
| 00000000 | 1111-1
Erw. | 1 : 5 | NORMAL |
00
| 00000000 |
00
| 00000000 | 1111-1
Erw. | 2 : 6 | NORMAL |
00
| 00000000 |
00
| 00000000 | 1111-1
-------|--------|--------|---------|----------|----------|----------|-------Baugruppencodierung Basis
: 0F = 00001111
DO 1
Blank:Redraw
S:Slow
DO 16
DI 1
F:Fast
DI 8
Other methods to determine digital input and output states is by probing the junction box mounted
on the rear of the cab, the C.U. 70-pass connector pins (X2), or specific resistors on the main
board, or terminal strip in the. See table above and sketches below. Be cautious not to short the
probe across connector pins.
Junction Box Assy located on rear exterior of cab
iFLEX 5
35-5
C.U. 70-pass
connector pins (X2)
Resistor bank to
measure digital input (DI)
state. Note: must
measure on bottom leg of
the resistor.
iFLEX 5
35-6
Another useful tool to monitor analog inputs and PWM outputs is utilizing the iTOOL5 or iFLASH
terminal function. At the flashing command prompt press and hold Ctrl and A to enter the
RTOS (an asterisk will display). Type adctest and press Enter. The result should be the screen
shown below.
*adctest
T E S T
D E R
A N A L O G E I N G A E N G E
===============================================
Ch | MUX | Error | Kanal+ | Value | Value | UADC | Special
|
|
| Valid | (Hex) | (Dec) | [mV] |
---+-----+-------+--------+-------+-------+------+----------------0 |
|
ok | 0008 | 0310 | 784 | 784 | I_Kanal 1 = 4.356 mA
1 |
|
ok | 0009 | 0816 | 2070 | 2070 | I_Kanal 2 = 11.500 mA
2 |
|
ok | 000A | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_Kanal 3 = 0.000 mA
3 |
|
ok | 000B | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_Kanal 4 = 0.000 mA
4 |
|
ok | 000C | 0307 | 775 | 775 | Temperature = +27C
5 | 0 |
ok | 000D | 0B90 | 2960 | 2960 | I_Kanal 5 = 16.444 mA
5 | 1 |
ok | 000D | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_Kanal 6 = 0.000 mA
5 | 2 |
ok | 000D | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_Kanal 7 = 0.000 mA
5 | 3 |
ok | 000D | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_Kanal 8 = 0.000 mA
5 | 4 |
ok | 000D | 0098 | 152 | 152 | I_PWM 1 =
0 mA
5 | 5 |
ok | 000D | 0014 |
20 |
20 | I_PWM 2 =
10 mA
5 | 6 |
ok | 000D | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_PWM 3 =
0 mA
5 | 7 |
ok | 000D | 0000 |
0 |
0 | I_PWM 4 =
0 mA
OPERATINGMODE
X: Exit
Blank: Redraw
S: Slow
F: Fast P: PWM-Settings
T: Testmode
O: Operatingmode
C: ADC-Clockset E: Extensionmodule T E S T
D E R
A N A L O G E I N G A E N G E
Kanal
1
2
3
5
Description
Slew Angle 1
Slew Angle 2
Wind Speed
Luffing Extension Offset Angle
PWM
1
2
3
4
Description
Center-Mid Tele Output
Inner-Mid Tele Output
Luffing Extension Raise Output
Luffing Extension Raise Output
Note: DO 1 = PWM 1
DO 3 = PWM 2
DO 5 = PWM 3
DO 7 = PWM 4
iFLEX 5
35-7
Boom Status /
Luffer Status
IM Tele Output
(0-255)
CM Tele Output
(0-255)
Length 2 (IM)
(feet)
Status No.
1 - 11
29
31 - 41
59
61 - 67
79
81 - 85
99
100
101
102 - 108
110
112
127
200 - 202
210 - 212
Description
Mode B extend
Error Mode B extend
Mode B retract
Error Mode B retract
Mode A extend
Error Mode A extend
Mode A retract
Error Mode A retract
Manual Mode A neutral or extend
Manual Mode B neutral or extend
Manual Mode retract at overload, A2B, error condition
Mode A, Out of Sequence
Mode B, Out of Sequence
Mode A or B, neutral position
Luffing jib raise
Luffing jib lower
iFLEX 5
35-8
boom section
percentage
display
IM retract sw.
(DI 7)
1
CM retract sw.
(DI 6)
1
Retract pressure
sw. (DI 18)
Extend pressure
sw. (DI 19)
OM/Fly
Percentage
>4%
iFLEX 5
IM rertract
sw. (DI 7)
CM retract
sw. (DI 6)
35-9
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 36
iFLEX 5
36-1
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 37
ERROR CODES
The following Error Code Table gives a brief description of Error Codes elimination. Refer to the noted
sections for detailed Troubleshooting information.
Possible Cause
E02
E03
E04
Elimination
Luff down the boom to a
radius or angle specified in
the load chart.
E05
Prohibited length
range
iFLEX 5
37-1
Error Code
E11
E12
E13
E14
E15
E16
E17
Error
Possible Cause
Elimination
Length potentiometer is
defective
Replace length
potentiometer, see
section Length Sensing
Pressure transducer is
defective.
Replace pressure
transducer, see section
Pressure Sensing
refer to E12
refer to E12
Force transducer
defective
Electronic component in
the measuring channel is
defective.
Angle potentiometer
defective
Replace force
transducer
Replace sensor unit
Electronic component in
the measuring channel
defective.
Angle potentiometer
defective
Replace electronic
board, see section
Angle Sensing
Refer to E-15
Electronic component in
the measuring channel
defective.
Length potentiometer
defective
Refer to E-15
Replace electronic
board, see section
Length Sensing
E18
Front outrigger
overloaded
Electronic component in
the measuring channel
defective
Front outrigger
overloaded
E1A
iFLEX 5
37-2
Error Code
E1B
E21
E22
E23
E24
E25
E26
E27
E2A
E2B
E31
Error
Possible Cause
Elimination
Slewing angle
Replace slewing angle
potentiometer is defective
sensor
Replace sensor unit
Electronic component in
the measuring channel
defective
refer to E1A
refer to E1A
refer to E11
refer to E11
refer to E12
refer to E12
refer to E12
refer to E12
refer to E14
refer to E14
refer to E15
refer to E15
refer to E16
refer to E16
refer to E17
refer to E17
refer to E1A
refer to E1A
refer to E1A
refer to E1A
Flash-EPROM defective
iFLEX 5
37-3
Error Code
E37
Error
Possible Cause
Elimination
E38
System program
and crane data file
do not match.
E39
System program
and load chart file
do not match
E43
Error in the
write/read memory,
(RAM)
Error in the
monitored write/
read memory.
E47
E51
The CRC
verification of the
monitored
write/read memory
provides an
incoherent result
Error in the crane
data file
Flash-EPROM defective
The system program in
the LMI does not match to
the programming in the
crane data file
The system program in
the LMI and the
programming in the load
chart file do not match.
Write/read memory
(RAM) or central unit
defective.
The CRC sign of the
monitored write/read
memory is wrong
E52
E56
E57
Flash-EPROM defective
Error in serial crane Calibration data file does
data file.
not contain valid data.
Flash-EPROM defective
No valid data in the load
chart file
E60
Flash-EPROM defective
Replace central unit
No valid data in the crane Restore or upload valid
crane data file
data file during
calibration.
iFLEX 5
37-4
Error Code
Error
Possible Cause
Elimination
E61
E62
E63
E64
E65
E66
E67
Check base
programming in the load
chart file.
CAN Bus cable between Check the connection
between the central unit
the central unit and the
and the sensor units
sensor units defective or
(wiring harness). See
not connected.
section CAN-Bus
Communication
Short circuit in a CAN Bus Replace Can Bus cable
cable
Can bus port in the
Replace the central unit
central unit defective
Check the cable to the
Cable between the
sensor unit (wiring
central unit and the
harness). See section
sensor unit defective or
CAN-Bus
not connected.
Communication
Sensor unit is defective
Replace the sensor unit
The analog values of the Replace the sensor unit
sensor unit are invalid
See section CAN-Bus
Communication.
Check the cable to the
Cable between the
sensor unit. See section
pressure transducer and
CAN-Bus
cable reel defective or not
connected.
Communication
Sensor unit is defective
Replace the electronic
board in the cable reel,
see section CAN-Bus
Communication
Angle sensor defective
Replace the angle
sensor, see section
CAN-Bus
Communication
Length sensor defective
Replace the length
sensor, see section
CAN-Bus
Communication
Sensor unit is defective
Replace the electronic
board in the cable reel,
see section CAN-Bus
Communication
See E62
See E62
iFLEX 5
See E63
37-5
Error Code
E68
E69
E80
E84
E85
Error
Possible Cause
Elimination
See E62
See E63
E89
Operating mode
switchover with
load.
E91
E92
E93
Interruption or accidental
ground in the line
between console
electronics and central
unit
Transmitter/receiver
module of console is
defective
Loose connection in the
line between console
electronics and central
unit
Transmitter/receiver
module is defective
refer to E92
iFLEX 5
37-6
Error Code
E94
E95
E96
E97
EAB
EAC
EAD
EC0
EC1
Error
Possible Cause
Elimination
Interruption or accidental
ground in the line central
unit console
Transmitter/receiver
module is defective
Computer module is
defective
Electro-magnetic
interferences (e.g. when
switching contactors or
valves)
Error in the console The console File is
File
defective.
Error in the internal The CPU of the console
RAM of the console.
is defective.
The console main board
is defective.
Error in the external The external RAM of the
RAM of the console
console is defective.
Note:
If an error message is displayed which is not contained in above list, please contact the PAT service
department.
iFLEX 5
37-7
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 38
TROUBLESHOOTING
MOISTURE
TROUBLESHOOTING MOISTURE
The PAT iFLEX5 LMI contains electronic components in various locations, such as central unit,
sensors, junction boxes etc. These internal components cannot be designed to withstand exposure to
moisture over a longer period of time. For this reason, the housings of the components are water
protected according to IP 65. If you find water or moisture inside any of the housings, the source for
the water ingress has to be detected and corrected to ensure proper operation.
There are two major possibilities for the occurrence of excessive moisture inside an enclosure:
1) Water ingress
2) Condensation
This outline gives instructions for detecting the cause for excessive moisture by using simple
troubleshooting methods and how to prevent the moisture ingress from happening again.
WATER INGRESS
There are 6 possibilities for water to enter an enclosure:
1) Spray Cleaning
2) Missing / Loose Screws
3) Bent Lid
4) Defective Gasket
5) Loose Strain Relieves
6) Water Entry Through External Cabling
It is possible to find out the source of water ingress by going through the following steps and ruling out
one possibility after the other until the cause is identified:
1) Spray Cleaning
The enclosures used for the PAT LMI system are water protected to IP 65. This means protection
against the environment, such as rain. However, through the use of spray cleaner at short
distances, it is possible to force water through the gasket or strain relieves. For this reason, avoid
spraying any components from short distances with spray cleaners. Convey this fact to any member
of a maintenance crew.
2) Missing / Loose Screws
All screws have to be present and to be equally tight to ensure water protection of the enclosure. If
there are screws missing, replace them. If no screw is missing, check the tightness. If any were
loose, then open all screws and then re-tighten them equally.
3) Bent Lid
An enclosure will only seal correctly if the lid is not bent. To check this, loosen all screws of the lid,
take the lid off the box and visually inspect it for deflection. If the lid is bent or damaged, it needs to
be replaced. Try to determine what has caused the lid to be bent and eliminate the reason for that.
Order a new lid through your PAT representative.
iFLEX 5
38-1
Troubleshooting Moisture
4) Defective Gasket
The gasket underneath the lid seals the unit. The gasket needs to be in good condition in order to
seal correctly. If the gasket is torn, brittle or severely bent, it needs to be replaced. Order a new
gasket through your PAT representative.
5) Loose Strain Relieves
The strain relieves allow cabling to enter the box without allowing water to enter it. The strain
relieves have to be correctly tightened in order to do this. Check the tightness by taking the external
cable into one hand and carefully trying to turn it. If the internal wires turn with the outer cable, the
strain relief is loose. Get a new grommet (insert) through your PAT representative and replace the
existing one with the new one. Tighten the strain relief correctly. Note: Whenever a strain relief is
opened, i.e. to replace a cable, a new grommet needs to be used. Never re-use any grommet or the
strain relief will not seal properly!
6) Water Entry Through External Cabling
Even with a tight strain relief, water may still enter the box through the inside of the cable. In this
case, you have to find out why and where water enters the cable. Look for damages to the cable
itself and inspect the opposite side of the cable. In example, if the cable comes from a connector
that is full of water, the water will run through the inside of the cable and fill up the central unit, too.
CONDENSATION
In a climate with high humidity and rapidly changing temperatures, condensation can happen inside
any enclosure, usually the larger the volume of the box, the more likely. In this case, water drops build
up on the inner components when humid air is trapped inside the box. With condensation, water
tightness is not a problem the box is sealed just fine, which is what prevents the trapped air from
exiting the box. There are two ways to deal with condensation:
1. If the volume is very small, a desiccant bag might be able to soak up the airs humidity.
2. If the effect is more severe, the only way to get rid of this effect is then to give the box the
ability to breath without sacrificing its water tightness. Contact your PAT representative for
breathing elements to than can be added to the box and will help to reduce the effects of
humid climates.
iFLEX 5
38-2
P.A.T. L.M.I
MANUAL
SECTION 39
SOFTWARE TRANSFER
INFORMATIONS INFORMATION
Attach the housing and the four inner screws from the rear of the Console, exposing the
internal boards.
Insert the console into the dash and mount in place with the 8 screws.
iFLEX 5
39-1
INSTALLING IFLASH
The iFLASH program must be installed onto the Palm. To install iflash on the Palm, use the hotsync
program of the Palm. The file name is iFLASH*.prc. Follow the normal Hotsync procedure for
transferring the program from the PC to the Palm. Instructions for Hotsync will be in your Palm
documentation or on Palm's web site.
iFLEX 5
39-2
PC
PC
- Select the file which you want to transfer and click "Open"
iFLEX 5
39-3
Software Transfer Instructions for the iFLASH Palm and Central Unit
Palm
Palm
Palm
Palm
PC
PC
Palm
- Start iflash
- Select File Store.
- Select Receive.
- palm will show "waiting for connection"
- click on OK.
- When the transfer is complete the following message will appear.
iFLEX 5
39-4
PC
- Click on Refresh File List
Palm
- Start iflash
Palm
- Select File Store.
Palm
- Select Send.
Palm
- palm will show "sending Filelist"
PC
- When the transfer is complete the window will be updated with the files from
the Palm file store.
iFLEX 5
39-5
Software Transfer Instructions for the iFLASH Palm and Central Unit
Palm
PC
Palm
PC
- select Receive.
Click OK.
Wait until Transfer completed is displayed in the status bar of the Palm.
Acknowledge the message on the PC:
The file has been successfully filed in the folder created by the iFLASH Palm Desktop.
iFLEX 5
39-6
Connect the Palm with the iFLEX5 via its serial cable.
Power the iFLEX system
Select iFLASH program
Select Settings. Note - The values are saved after the first time. This can be skipped later.
Set Speed to: 9600
Set Data Bits to: 8
Set Parity to: N
Set Stop Bits to: 1
Select Save.
Select Palm to iFLEX
Select the file to be transferred from the file selection box.
Select Start Transfer
Wait until all bytes have been transferred in the line Progress.
The data have been successfully transferred to the iFLEX5.
iFLEX 5
39-7
Software Transfer Instructions for the iFLASH Palm and Central Unit
Connect the Palm with the iFLEX5 via its serial cable.
Power the iFLEX system
Select iFLASH program
Select Settings.
Select Settings. Note - The values are saved after the first time. This can be skipped later.
Set Data Bits to: 8
Set Parity to: N
Set Stop Bits to: 1
Select Save.
Select iFLEX to Palm
Select the corresponding parameter data file in the displayed selection box. See parameter file
section.
Select the file to be transferred from the file selection box.
Using your Stylus, check off either save brn file or save bin file in the selection Save file as
depending on how you want the file to be stored.
Select Start Transfer
Wait until the message complete appears in the line Progress
If this file name exists already in the Filestore, it will be counted upward by one.
Example: Parameter file :12k.ADR
PARAMETER FILES
There are several files required for transferring from iflex to palm. These files are called parameter
files. You should have a parameter file for each of the file types that you wish to transfer from the iflex
to the Palm. These files will have a "adr" extension on the filename. Examples are tlkprom.adr,
datprom.adr. These files must be transferred from the PC to the Palm using the file store program.
Please contact PAT for information on acquiring these files.
iFLEX 5
39-8